]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blob - gcc/doc/tm.texi
re PR other/66259 (Combined gcc and binutils build from git-master fails, with gas...
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi
1 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
2 @c This is part of the GCC manual.
3 @c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
4
5 @node Target Macros
6 @chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
7 @cindex machine description macros
8 @cindex target description macros
9 @cindex macros, target description
10 @cindex @file{tm.h} macros
11
12 In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
13 includes a C header file conventionally given the name
14 @file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
15 The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
16 about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
17 @file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
18 @file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
19 @file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
20 source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
21 containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
22 machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
23 if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
24 through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
25
26 @menu
27 * Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
28 * Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
29 * Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
30 * Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
31 * Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
32 * Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
33 * Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
34 * Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
35 * Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
36 * Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
37 * Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
38 * Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
39 * Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
40 * Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
41 * Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
42 * Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
43 * Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
44 * Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
45 * PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
46 * Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
47 * Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
48 * Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
49 * Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
50 * Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
51 * Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
52 * MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
53 * PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
54 * C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
55 * Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
56 * Misc:: Everything else.
57 @end menu
58
59 @node Target Structure
60 @section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
61 @cindex target hooks
62 @cindex target functions
63
64 @deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
65 The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
66 which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
67 machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
68 @file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
69 used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
70 for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
71 macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
72 @smallexample
73 #include "target.h"
74 #include "target-def.h"
75
76 /* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
77
78 #undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
79 #define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
80
81 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
82 @end smallexample
83 @end deftypevar
84
85 Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
86 form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
87 ``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
88 from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
89 @code{targetm} structure.
90
91 Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
92 specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
93 Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
94 initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
95 @file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
96 themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
97 @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
98
99 Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that
100 are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper,
101 documented as ``Common Target Hook''. This is declared in
102 @file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer
103 @code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in
104 @file{common/common-target-def.h}. If targets initialize
105 @code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set
106 @code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a
107 default definition is used.
108
109 @node Driver
110 @section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
111 @cindex driver
112 @cindex controlling the compilation driver
113
114 @c prevent bad page break with this line
115 You can control the compilation driver.
116
117 @defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
118 A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
119 initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
120
121 The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
122 default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
123 choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
124 applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
125 options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
126 using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
127
128 This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
129 options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
130 that the other specs are easier to write.
131
132 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
133 @end defmac
134
135 @defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
136 A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
137 @option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
138 for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
139 outermost pair of surrounding braces.
140
141 The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
142 the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
143 to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
144 @samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
145 everywhere it occurs.
146
147 The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
148 default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
149 the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
150
151 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
152 @end defmac
153
154 @defmac CPP_SPEC
155 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
156 pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
157 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
158
159 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
160 @end defmac
161
162 @defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
163 This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
164 than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
165 @code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
166 @end defmac
167
168 @defmac CC1_SPEC
169 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
170 pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
171 front ends.
172 It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
173 for GCC to pass to front ends.
174
175 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
176 @end defmac
177
178 @defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
179 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
180 pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
181 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
182
183 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
184 Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
185 @code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
186 CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
187 @end defmac
188
189 @defmac ASM_SPEC
190 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
191 pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
192 you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
193 See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
194
195 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
196 @end defmac
197
198 @defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
199 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
200 run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
201 Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
202 an example of this.
203
204 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
205 @end defmac
206
207 @defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
208 Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
209 an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
210 read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
211 output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
212 @option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
213
214 If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
215 standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
216 cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
217 see @file{mips.h} for instance.
218 @end defmac
219
220 @defmac LINK_SPEC
221 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
222 pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
223 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
224
225 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
226 @end defmac
227
228 @defmac LIB_SPEC
229 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
230 between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
231 command given to the linker.
232
233 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
234 loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
235 @end defmac
236
237 @defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
238 Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
239 how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
240 linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
241 the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
242
243 If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
244 passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
245 @end defmac
246
247 @defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
248 By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
249 @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
250 instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
251 depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
252 @option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
253 targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
254 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
255 driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
256 line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
257 @end defmac
258
259 @defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
260 A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
261 mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
262 generated that uses @option{--as-needed} or equivalent options and the
263 shared @file{libgcc} in place of the
264 static exception handler library, when linking without any of
265 @code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
266 @end defmac
267
268 @defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
269 If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
270 When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
271 the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
272 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
273 @end defmac
274
275 @defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
276 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
277 difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
278 the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
279
280 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
281 standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
282 @end defmac
283
284 @defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
285 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
286 difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
287 the very end of the command given to the linker.
288
289 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
290 @end defmac
291
292 @defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
293 GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
294 However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
295 models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
296 @code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
297 blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
298 default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
299 @code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
300 @end defmac
301
302 @defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
303 Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
304 configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
305 et al, within sysroot+suffix.
306 @end defmac
307
308 @defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
309 Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
310 GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
311 updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
312 usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
313 @end defmac
314
315 @defmac EXTRA_SPECS
316 Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
317 @file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
318 @code{CC1_SPEC}.
319
320 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
321 containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
322 string constant that provides the specification.
323
324 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
325
326 @code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
327 related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
328 to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
329 these definitions.
330
331 For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
332 define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
333 used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
334 used.
335
336 The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
337
338 @smallexample
339 #define EXTRA_SPECS \
340 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
341
342 #define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
343 @end smallexample
344
345 The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
346 @smallexample
347 #undef CPP_SPEC
348 #define CPP_SPEC \
349 "%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
350 %@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
351 %@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
352 %@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
353
354 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
355 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
356 @end smallexample
357
358 while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
359 @code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
360
361 @smallexample
362 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
363 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
364 @end smallexample
365 @end defmac
366
367 @defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
368 Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
369 @file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
370 the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
371 @end defmac
372
373 @defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
374 The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
375 By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
376 @end defmac
377
378 @defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
379 A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
380 linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
381 change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
382 define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
383 line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
384 the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
385 @code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
386 @end defmac
387
388 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT
389 True if @file{..} components should always be removed from directory names computed relative to GCC's internal directories, false (default) if such components should be preserved and directory names containing them passed to other tools such as the linker.
390 @end deftypevr
391
392 @defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
393 Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
394 string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
395 target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
396 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
397
398 Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
399 the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
400 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
401 @xref{Target Fragment}.
402 @end defmac
403
404 @defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
405 Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
406 a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
407 indicates an absolute file name.
408 @end defmac
409
410 @defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
411 If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
412 @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
413 when the compiler is built as a cross
414 compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
415 to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.ac}.
416 @end defmac
417
418 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
419 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
420 standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
421 try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
422 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
423 is built as a cross compiler.
424 @end defmac
425
426 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
427 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
428 standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
429 when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
430 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
431 is built as a cross compiler.
432 @end defmac
433
434 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
435 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
436 standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
437 default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
438 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
439 is built as a cross compiler.
440 @end defmac
441
442 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
443 If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
444 standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
445 compiler is built as a cross compiler.
446 @end defmac
447
448 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
449 If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
450 standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
451 cross compiler.
452 @end defmac
453
454 @defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
455 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
456 variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
457 loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
458 initialize the necessary environment variables.
459 @end defmac
460
461 @defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
462 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
463 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
464 try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
465 comes before @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR} (set in
466 @file{config.gcc}, normally @file{/usr/include}) in the search order.
467
468 Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
469 replacement.
470 @end defmac
471
472 @defmac NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_COMPONENT
473 The ``component'' corresponding to @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}.
474 See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
475 If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
476 @end defmac
477
478 @defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
479 Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
480 for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
481 usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
482 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
483 @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
484 and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
485 and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
486 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
487
488 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
489 Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
490 string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
491 for C++-only directories,
492 and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
493 wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
494 the array with a null element.
495
496 The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
497 if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
498 or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
499 operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
500
501 For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
502
503 @smallexample
504 #define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
505 @{ \
506 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
507 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
508 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
509 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
510 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
511 @}
512 @end smallexample
513 @end defmac
514
515 Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
516
517 @enumerate
518 @item
519 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
520
521 @item
522 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
523 is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
524 @var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
525
526 @item
527 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
528
529 @item
530 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
531 in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
532
533 @item
534 The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
535
536 @item
537 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
538
539 @item
540 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
541 compiler.
542 @end enumerate
543
544 Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
545
546 @enumerate
547 @item
548 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
549
550 @item
551 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
552 value based on the installed toolchain location.
553
554 @item
555 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
556 (or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
557
558 @item
559 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
560 in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
561
562 @item
563 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
564
565 @item
566 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
567 compiler.
568
569 @item
570 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
571 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
572
573 @item
574 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
575 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
576
577 @item
578 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
579 If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
580 the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
581
582 @item
583 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
584 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
585 @file{/lib/}.
586
587 @item
588 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
589 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
590 @file{/usr/lib/}.
591 @end enumerate
592
593 @node Run-time Target
594 @section Run-time Target Specification
595 @cindex run-time target specification
596 @cindex predefined macros
597 @cindex target specifications
598
599 @c prevent bad page break with this line
600 Here are run-time target specifications.
601
602 @defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
603 This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
604 built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
605 the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
606 @code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
607 calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
608 finished command line option processing your code can use those
609 results freely.
610
611 @code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
612 command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
613 the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
614 accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
615
616 @code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
617 object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
618 @code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
619 defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
620 with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
621 only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
622 example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
623 and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
624 @code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
625 defines only @code{_ABI64}.
626
627 You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
628 @code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
629 or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
630 assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
631 macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
632 to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
633 variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
634 @code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
635 preprocessing.
636 @end defmac
637
638 @defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
639 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
640 and is used for the target operating system instead.
641 @end defmac
642
643 @defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
644 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
645 and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
646 macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
647 it yourself.
648 @end defmac
649
650 @deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
651 This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
652 any target-specific headers.
653 @end deftypevar
654
655 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} int TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
656 This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
657 Its default setting is 0.
658 @end deftypevr
659
660 @cindex optional hardware or system features
661 @cindex features, optional, in system conventions
662
663 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts_set}, const struct cl_decoded_option *@var{decoded}, location_t @var{loc})
664 This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
665 target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
666 (@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
667 processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
668 definition does nothing but return true.
669
670 @var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and
671 @var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
672 storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
673 option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
674 via attributes).
675 @end deftypefn
676
677 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION (size_t @var{code}, const char *@var{arg}, int @var{value})
678 This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
679 target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
680 definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
681 option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
682 valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
683 default definition does nothing but return false.
684
685 In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
686 options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
687 only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
688 should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
689 @end deftypefn
690
691 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} tree TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT (tree @var{string})
692 Targets may provide a string object type that can be used within and between C, C++ and their respective Objective-C dialects. A string object might, for example, embed encoding and length information. These objects are considered opaque to the compiler and handled as references. An ideal implementation makes the composition of the string object match that of the Objective-C @code{NSString} (@code{NXString} for GNUStep), allowing efficient interworking between C-only and Objective-C code. If a target implements string objects then this hook should return a reference to such an object constructed from the normal `C' string representation provided in @var{string}. At present, the hook is used by Objective-C only, to obtain a common-format string object when the target provides one.
693 @end deftypefn
694
695 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_CLASS_REFERENCE (const char *@var{classname})
696 Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is referenced by the current TU.
697 @end deftypefn
698
699 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_CLASS_DEFINITION (const char *@var{classname})
700 Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is defined by the current TU.
701 @end deftypefn
702
703 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P (const_tree @var{stringref})
704 If a target implements string objects then this hook should return @code{true} if @var{stringref} is a valid reference to such an object.
705 @end deftypefn
706
707 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG (tree @var{format_arg}, tree @var{args_list})
708 If a target implements string objects then this hook should should provide a facility to check the function arguments in @var{args_list} against the format specifiers in @var{format_arg} where the type of @var{format_arg} is one recognized as a valid string reference type.
709 @end deftypefn
710
711 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE (void)
712 This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
713 but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
714 pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
715 attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
716 when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
717 actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
718 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
719 @end deftypefn
720
721 @defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
722 This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
723 but is only used in the C
724 language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
725 used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
726 frontends.
727 @end defmac
728
729 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} {const struct default_options *} TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
730 Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
731 various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
732 options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
733 options are processed once
734 just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
735 of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
736 options passed explicitly.
737
738 This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
739 options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
740 @code{optimize} attribute.
741 @end deftypevr
742
743 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
744 Set target-dependent initial values of fields in @var{opts}.
745 @end deftypefn
746
747 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS (void)
748 Set target-dependent default values for @option{--param} settings, using calls to @code{set_default_param_value}.
749 @end deftypefn
750
751 @defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
752 Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
753 during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
754 the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
755 can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
756 and @code{nomips16} attributes.
757
758 Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
759 registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
760 operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
761 in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
762 significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
763 for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
764 switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
765
766 Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
767 is 0.
768 @end defmac
769
770 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FLOAT_EXCEPTIONS_ROUNDING_SUPPORTED_P (void)
771 Returns true if the target supports IEEE 754 floating-point exceptions and rounding modes, false otherwise. This is intended to relate to the @code{float} and @code{double} types, but not necessarily @code{long double}. By default, returns true if the @code{adddf3} instruction pattern is available and false otherwise, on the assumption that hardware floating point supports exceptions and rounding modes but software floating point does not.
772 @end deftypefn
773
774 @node Per-Function Data
775 @section Defining data structures for per-function information.
776 @cindex per-function data
777 @cindex data structures
778
779 If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
780 provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
781 using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
782 nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
783 when another one comes along.
784
785 GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
786 contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
787 structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
788 @code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
789 to their own specific data.
790
791 If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
792 @code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
793 This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
794 @code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
795
796 One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
797 RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
798 RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
799 function, for level 0.
800
801 Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
802 all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
803 function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
804 stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
805 stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
806 @code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
807 the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
808 single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
809 longer supported.
810
811 @defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
812 Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
813 is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
814 The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
815 function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
816 @end defmac
817
818 @deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
819 If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
820 function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
821 target to perform any target specific initialization of the
822 @code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
823 used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
824
825 @code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
826 Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
827 GC allocation, including the structure itself.
828 @end deftypevar
829
830 @node Storage Layout
831 @section Storage Layout
832 @cindex storage layout
833
834 Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
835 alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
836 expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
837 @xref{Run-time Target}.
838
839 @defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
840 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
841 byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
842 This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
843 bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
844 be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
845 macro need not be a constant.
846
847 This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
848 bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
849 @end defmac
850
851 @defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
852 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
853 word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
854 @end defmac
855
856 @defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
857 Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
858 most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
859 memory locations and registers; see @code{REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} if the
860 order of words in memory is not the same as the order in registers. This
861 macro need not be a constant.
862 @end defmac
863
864 @defmac REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
865 On some machines, the order of words in a multiword object differs between
866 registers in memory. In such a situation, define this macro to describe
867 the order of words in a register. The macro @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} controls
868 the order of words in memory.
869 @end defmac
870
871 @defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
872 Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
873 @code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
874 containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
875 have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
876
877 You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
878 multi-word integers.
879 @end defmac
880
881 @defmac BITS_PER_WORD
882 Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
883 is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
884 @end defmac
885
886 @defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
887 Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
888 @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
889 largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
890 @end defmac
891
892 @defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
893 Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
894 register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
895 @end defmac
896
897 @defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
898 Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
899 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
900 smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
901 @end defmac
902
903 @defmac POINTER_SIZE
904 Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
905 width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
906 you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
907 a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
908 @end defmac
909
910 @defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
911 A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
912 @code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
913 greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
914 should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
915 is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
916 @code{ptr_extend} instruction.
917
918 You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
919 and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
920 @end defmac
921
922 @defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
923 A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
924 is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
925 stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
926 scalar type.
927
928 On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
929 register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
930 @var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
931 cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
932 floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
933 counterparts.
934
935 For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
936 However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
937 either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
938 the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
939 sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
940 @var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
941
942 Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
943 @end defmac
944
945 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE (const_tree @var{type}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int *@var{punsignedp}, const_tree @var{funtype}, int @var{for_return})
946 Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
947 function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
948 and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
949 change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
950 pointer} types.
951
952 @var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
953 return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
954 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
955 If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
956 which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
957 then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
958 the signedness may be different.
959
960 @var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
961
962 The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
963 also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
964 if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
965 @end deftypefn
966
967 @defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
968 Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
969 bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
970 regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
971 size of an integer.
972 @end defmac
973
974 @defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
975 Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
976 stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
977 desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
978 if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
979 this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
980 @end defmac
981
982 @defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
983 Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
984 stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
985 is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
986 macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
987 @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
988 @end defmac
989
990 @defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
991 Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
992 from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
993 to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
994 @end defmac
995
996 @defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
997 Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
998 @end defmac
999
1000 @defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1001 Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1002 bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1003 just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
1004 @end defmac
1005
1006 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_ABSOLUTE_BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1007 If defined, this target hook specifies the absolute biggest alignment
1008 that a type or variable can have on this machine, otherwise,
1009 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} is used.
1010 @end deftypevr
1011
1012 @defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1013 Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1014 provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1015 @end defmac
1016
1017 @defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1018 Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1019 not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1020 @end defmac
1021
1022 @defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1023 If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1024 object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1025 nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1026 on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1027 @end defmac
1028
1029 @defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1030 Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1031 machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1032 structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1033 by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1034 @end defmac
1035
1036 @defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1037 An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1038 alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1039 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1040 alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1041 field alignment has not been set by the
1042 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1043 @end defmac
1044
1045 @defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1046 Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1047 to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1048
1049 If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1050
1051 @c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1052 @c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1053 @c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1054 @c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1055 @end defmac
1056
1057 @defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1058 Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1059 Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1060 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1061 the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1062
1063 On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1064 the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1065 a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((uint64_t) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1066 On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1067 @samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1068 @end defmac
1069
1070 @defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1071 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1072 the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1073 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1074 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1075
1076 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1077
1078 @findex strcpy
1079 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1080 make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1081 arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1082 constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1083 @end defmac
1084
1085 @defmac DATA_ABI_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1086 Similar to @code{DATA_ALIGNMENT}, but for the cases where the ABI mandates
1087 some alignment increase, instead of optimization only purposes. E.g.@
1088 AMD x86-64 psABI says that variables with array type larger than 15 bytes
1089 must be aligned to 16 byte boundaries.
1090
1091 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1092 @end defmac
1093
1094 @defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1095 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1096 that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1097 @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1098 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1099 align the object.
1100
1101 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1102
1103 The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1104 constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1105 constants can be done inline.
1106 @end defmac
1107
1108 @defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1109 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1110 the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1111 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1112 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1113
1114 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1115
1116 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1117 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1118
1119 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1120 @end defmac
1121
1122 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{type})
1123 This hook can be used to define the alignment for a vector of type
1124 @var{type}, in order to comply with a platform ABI. The default is to
1125 require natural alignment for vector types. The alignment returned by
1126 this hook must be a power-of-two multiple of the default alignment of
1127 the vector element type.
1128 @end deftypefn
1129
1130 @defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1131 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1132 @var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1133 and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1134 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1135 align the slot.
1136
1137 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1138 @var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1139 be used.
1140
1141 This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1142 of all possible modes which the slot may have.
1143
1144 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1145 @end defmac
1146
1147 @defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1148 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1149 variable @var{decl}.
1150
1151 If this macro is not defined, then
1152 @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1153 is used.
1154
1155 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1156 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1157
1158 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1159 @end defmac
1160
1161 @defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1162 If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1163 for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1164 @var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1165
1166 If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1167 @end defmac
1168
1169 @defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1170 Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1171 empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1172
1173 If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1174 @end defmac
1175
1176 @defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1177 Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1178 Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1179
1180 If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1181 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1182 @end defmac
1183
1184 @defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1185 Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1186 if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1187 go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1188 @end defmac
1189
1190 @defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1191 Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1192 alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1193
1194 The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1195 @code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1196 structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1197 that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1198 that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1199
1200 Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1201 @code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1202 four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1203 not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1204
1205 An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1206 structure.
1207
1208 If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1209 a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1210
1211 Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1212 bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1213 support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1214 @samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1215
1216 The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1217 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1218 Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1219
1220 Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1221 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1222 @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1223
1224 If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1225 bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1226 what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1227
1228 @smallexample
1229 struct foo1
1230 @{
1231 char x;
1232 char :0;
1233 char y;
1234 @};
1235
1236 struct foo2
1237 @{
1238 char x;
1239 int :0;
1240 char y;
1241 @};
1242
1243 main ()
1244 @{
1245 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1246 sizeof (struct foo1));
1247 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1248 sizeof (struct foo2));
1249 exit (0);
1250 @}
1251 @end smallexample
1252
1253 If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1254 get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1255 @end defmac
1256
1257 @defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1258 Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1259 to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1260 @end defmac
1261
1262 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD (void)
1263 When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1264 whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1265 structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1266 the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1267 @end deftypefn
1268
1269 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD (void)
1270 This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1271 should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1272 these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1273
1274 The default is @code{false}.
1275 @end deftypefn
1276
1277 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (const_tree @var{field}, machine_mode @var{mode})
1278 Return true if a structure, union or array containing @var{field} should
1279 be accessed using @code{BLKMODE}.
1280
1281 If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1282 mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1283 case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1284 retain the field's mode.
1285
1286 Normally, this is not needed.
1287 @end deftypefn
1288
1289 @defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1290 Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1291 by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1292 way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1293 @var{specified}.
1294
1295 The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1296 the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1297 @end defmac
1298
1299 @defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1300 An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1301 machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1302 this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1303 appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1304 (DImode)} is assumed.
1305 @end defmac
1306
1307 @defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1308 If defined, an expression of type @code{machine_mode} that
1309 specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1310 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1311 @var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1312 @code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1313 having its mode specified.
1314
1315 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1316 would most commonly define this macro if the
1317 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
1318 64-bit mode.
1319 @end defmac
1320
1321 @defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1322 If defined, an expression of type @code{machine_mode} that
1323 specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1324 @code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1325
1326 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1327 You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1328 pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1329 @end defmac
1330
1331 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE (void)
1332 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1333 of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1334 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1335 targets.
1336 @end deftypefn
1337
1338 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE (void)
1339 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1340 of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1341 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1342 targets.
1343 @end deftypefn
1344
1345 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE (void)
1346 Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1347 The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1348 @end deftypefn
1349
1350 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (const_tree @var{record_type})
1351 This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1352 @var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1353 Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1354 unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1355 different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1356 alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1357 bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1358 the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1359 (iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1360 another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1361 other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1362
1363 When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1364 of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1365 bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1366 and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1367 chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1368 size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1369 alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1370
1371 If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1372 the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1373 used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1374 precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1375 may affect its placement.
1376 @end deftypefn
1377
1378 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1379 Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1380 @end deftypefn
1381
1382 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1383 Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1384 @end deftypefn
1385
1386 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK (void)
1387 This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1388 to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1389 For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1390 for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1391 registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1392 usage.
1393 @end deftypefn
1394
1395 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS (void)
1396 This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1397 that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1398 @end deftypefn
1399
1400 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
1401 If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1402 uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1403 to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1404 mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1405 the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1406 not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1407 for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1408 return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1409 string constant.
1410
1411 Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1412 qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1413 fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1414 is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1415 length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1416 ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1417 @var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1418 @var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1419 code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1420 @code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1421 codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1422 spaces in your string.
1423
1424 This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1425 name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1426 can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1427 before mangling.
1428
1429 The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1430 appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1431 types.
1432 @end deftypefn
1433
1434 @node Type Layout
1435 @section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1436
1437 These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1438 basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1439 the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1440 languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1441
1442 @defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1443 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1444 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1445 @end defmac
1446
1447 @defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1448 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1449 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1450 (If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1451 unit.)
1452 @end defmac
1453
1454 @defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1455 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1456 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1457 @end defmac
1458
1459 @defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1460 On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1461 @code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1462 that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1463 the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1464 value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1465 @end defmac
1466
1467 @defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1468 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1469 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1470 words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1471 macro must be at least 64.
1472 @end defmac
1473
1474 @defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1475 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1476 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1477 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1478 @end defmac
1479
1480 @defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1481 A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1482 C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1483 this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1484 @end defmac
1485
1486 @defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1487 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1488 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1489 @end defmac
1490
1491 @defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1492 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1493 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1494 words.
1495 @end defmac
1496
1497 @defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1498 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1499 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1500 words.
1501 @end defmac
1502
1503 @defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1504 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1505 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1506 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1507 @end defmac
1508
1509 @defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1510 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1511 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1512 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1513 @end defmac
1514
1515 @defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1516 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1517 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1518 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1519 @end defmac
1520
1521 @defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1522 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1523 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1524 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1525 @end defmac
1526
1527 @defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1528 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1529 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1530 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1531 @end defmac
1532
1533 @defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1534 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1535 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1536 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1537 @end defmac
1538
1539 @defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1540 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1541 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1542 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1543 @end defmac
1544
1545 @defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1546 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1547 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1548 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1549 @end defmac
1550
1551 @defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1552 This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1553 hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true. It
1554 causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1555 prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}. A port which
1556 uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1557 the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1558 @end defmac
1559
1560 @defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1561 A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1562 assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1563 default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1564 @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1565 @end defmac
1566
1567 @defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1568 A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1569 supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1570 value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1571 If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1572 is the default.
1573 @end defmac
1574
1575 @defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1576 An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1577 @code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1578 always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1579 and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1580 @end defmac
1581
1582 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS (void)
1583 This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1584 @code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1585 of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1586 @code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1587
1588 The default is to return false.
1589 @end deftypefn
1590
1591 @defmac SIZE_TYPE
1592 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1593 for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1594 contents of the string.
1595
1596 The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1597 spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1598 appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1599 of the data type names defined in the function
1600 @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins} in the file @file{c-family/c-common.c}.
1601 You may not omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the
1602 compiler to crash on startup.
1603
1604 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1605 int"}.
1606 @end defmac
1607
1608 @defmac SIZETYPE
1609 GCC defines internal types (@code{sizetype}, @code{ssizetype},
1610 @code{bitsizetype} and @code{sbitsizetype}) for expressions
1611 dealing with size. This macro is a C expression for a string describing
1612 the name of the data type from which the precision of @code{sizetype}
1613 is extracted.
1614
1615 The string has the same restrictions as @code{SIZE_TYPE} string.
1616
1617 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{SIZE_TYPE}.
1618 @end defmac
1619
1620 @defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1621 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1622 for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1623 @code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1624 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1625
1626 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1627 @end defmac
1628
1629 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1630 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1631 for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1632 the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1633 information.
1634
1635 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1636 @end defmac
1637
1638 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1639 A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1640 characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1641 @code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1642 @end defmac
1643
1644 @defmac WINT_TYPE
1645 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1646 use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1647 @code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1648 contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1649 information.
1650
1651 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1652 @end defmac
1653
1654 @defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1655 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1656 can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1657 The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1658 string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1659
1660 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1661 @code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1662 much precision as @code{long long int}.
1663 @end defmac
1664
1665 @defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1666 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1667 can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1668 type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1669 of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1670
1671 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1672 @code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1673 unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1674 int}.
1675 @end defmac
1676
1677 @defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1678 @defmacx INT8_TYPE
1679 @defmacx INT16_TYPE
1680 @defmacx INT32_TYPE
1681 @defmacx INT64_TYPE
1682 @defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1683 @defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1684 @defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1685 @defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1686 @defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1687 @defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1688 @defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1689 @defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1690 @defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1691 @defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1692 @defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1693 @defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1694 @defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1695 @defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1696 @defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1697 @defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1698 @defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1699 @defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1700 @defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1701 @defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1702 @defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1703 @defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1704 C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1705 @code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1706 @code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1707 @code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1708 @code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1709 @code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1710 @code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1711 @code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1712 @code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1713 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1714
1715 If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1716 type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1717 @code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1718 to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1719 these macros are null pointers.
1720 @end defmac
1721
1722 @defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1723 The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1724 that looks like:
1725
1726 @smallexample
1727 struct @{
1728 union @{
1729 void (*fn)();
1730 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1731 @};
1732 ptrdiff_t delta;
1733 @};
1734 @end smallexample
1735
1736 @noindent
1737 The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1738 will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1739 Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1740 always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1741 distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1742 platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1743 that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1744 the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1745
1746 GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1747 this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1748 However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1749 set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1750 bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1751 address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1752 architecture, you should define this macro to
1753 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1754
1755 In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1756 in which function addresses are always even, according to
1757 @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1758 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1759 @end defmac
1760
1761 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1762 Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1763 macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1764 instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1765 function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1766 data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1767 pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1768
1769 If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1770 of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1771 @end defmac
1772
1773 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1774 By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1775 is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1776 the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1777 when special alignment is necessary. */
1778 @end defmac
1779
1780 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1781 There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1782 zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1783 specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1784 of words in each data entry.
1785 @end defmac
1786
1787 @node Registers
1788 @section Register Usage
1789 @cindex register usage
1790
1791 This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1792 has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1793
1794 The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1795 done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1796 on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1797 For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1798 For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1799
1800 @menu
1801 * Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1802 * Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1803 * Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1804 * Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1805 * Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1806 @end menu
1807
1808 @node Register Basics
1809 @subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1810
1811 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1812 Registers have various characteristics.
1813
1814 @defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1815 Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1816 numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1817 pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1818 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1819 @end defmac
1820
1821 @defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1822 @cindex fixed register
1823 An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1824 all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1825 general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1826 pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1827 register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1828 machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1829 and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1830
1831 This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1832 commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1833 register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1834
1835 The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1836 the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1837 by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1838 the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1839 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1840 @end defmac
1841
1842 @defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1843 @cindex call-used register
1844 @cindex call-clobbered register
1845 @cindex call-saved register
1846 Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1847 clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1848 registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1849 available for general allocation of values that must live across
1850 function calls.
1851
1852 If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1853 automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1854 exit, if the register is used within the function.
1855 @end defmac
1856
1857 @defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1858 @cindex call-used register
1859 @cindex call-clobbered register
1860 @cindex call-saved register
1861 Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1862 that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1863 (@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1864 This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1865 of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1866 @end defmac
1867
1868 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1869 @cindex call-used register
1870 @cindex call-clobbered register
1871 @cindex call-saved register
1872 A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1873 value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1874 call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1875 macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1876 preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1877 @end defmac
1878
1879 @findex fixed_regs
1880 @findex call_used_regs
1881 @findex global_regs
1882 @findex reg_names
1883 @findex reg_class_contents
1884 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE (void)
1885 This hook may conditionally modify five variables
1886 @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1887 @code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1888 any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1889 of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1890 @code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1891 @code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1892 called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1893 @code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1894 from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1895 @code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1896 @code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1897 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1898 command options have been applied.
1899
1900 @cindex disabling certain registers
1901 @cindex controlling register usage
1902 If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1903 flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1904 @code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1905 registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also make
1906 @code{define_register_constraint}s return @code{NO_REGS} for constraints
1907 that shouldn't be used.
1908
1909 (However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1910 of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1911 controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1912 these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1913 @end deftypefn
1914
1915 @defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1916 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1917 expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1918 corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1919 function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1920 outbound register.
1921 @end defmac
1922
1923 @defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1924 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1925 expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1926 corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1927 function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1928 register.
1929 @end defmac
1930
1931 @defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1932 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1933 expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1934 register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1935 need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1936 gotos.
1937 @end defmac
1938
1939 @defmac PC_REGNUM
1940 If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1941 register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
1942 @end defmac
1943
1944 @node Allocation Order
1945 @subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1946 @cindex order of register allocation
1947 @cindex register allocation order
1948
1949 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1950 Registers are allocated in order.
1951
1952 @defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1953 If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
1954 numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
1955 to use them (from most preferred to least).
1956
1957 If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1958 (all else being equal).
1959
1960 One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1961 registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1962 instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
1963 machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
1964 the highest numbered allocable register first.
1965 @end defmac
1966
1967 @defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1968 A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
1969 hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
1970
1971 Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
1972 Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
1973 register; and so on.
1974
1975 The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
1976 @code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
1977
1978 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
1979 @end defmac
1980
1981 @defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1982 Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
1983 prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
1984 using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
1985 allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
1986 call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, then define this
1987 macro as a C expression to nonzero. Default is 0.
1988 @end defmac
1989
1990 @defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
1991 In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
1992 Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
1993 If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
1994 based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
1995 be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
1996 value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
1997 to having it always return @code{0.0}.
1998
1999 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2000 @end defmac
2001
2002 @node Values in Registers
2003 @subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2004
2005 This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2006 (specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2007 consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2008
2009 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2010 A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2011 at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2012 @var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2013 cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2014 and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2015
2016 On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2017 definition of this macro is
2018
2019 @smallexample
2020 #define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2021 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2022 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2023 @end smallexample
2024 @end defmac
2025
2026 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2027 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2028 in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2029 in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2030 multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2031 this mode by the number of registers returned by
2032 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2033
2034 For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2035 registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2036 nonzero.
2037
2038 This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2039 @code{subreg_get_info}
2040 would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2041 represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2042 @code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2043 registers and so not be representable.
2044 @end defmac
2045
2046 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2047 For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2048 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2049 returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2050 including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2051 @end defmac
2052
2053 @defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2054 Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2055 of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2056 should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2057 used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2058 happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2059 floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2060 @end defmac
2061
2062 @defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2063 A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2064 of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2065 registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2066 are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2067
2068 @smallexample
2069 #define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2070 @end smallexample
2071
2072 You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2073 because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2074
2075 @cindex register pairs
2076 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2077 register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2078 odd register numbers for such modes.
2079
2080 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2081 @samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2082 register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2083 value into the register and back out not alter it.
2084
2085 Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2086 all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2087 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2088 you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2089 is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2090 and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2091 to be tieable.
2092
2093 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2094 Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2095 in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2096 can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2097 mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2098 registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2099
2100 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2101 modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2102 registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2103 non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2104 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2105 floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2106 normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2107 unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2108 register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2109
2110 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2111 they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2112 instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2113 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2114 constraints for those instructions.
2115
2116 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2117 so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2118 register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2119 floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2120 be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2121 @end defmac
2122
2123 @defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2124 A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2125 @var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2126
2127 One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2128 another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2129 handler.
2130
2131 The default is always nonzero.
2132 @end defmac
2133
2134 @defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2135 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2136 @var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2137
2138 If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2139 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2140 any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2141 should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2142 this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2143 accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2144
2145 You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2146 possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2147 allocation.
2148 @end defmac
2149
2150 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK (unsigned int @var{regno})
2151 This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2152 @var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2153
2154 One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2155 is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2156
2157 The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2158 @end deftypefn
2159
2160 @defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2161 Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2162 registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2163 @code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2164 @end defmac
2165
2166 @node Leaf Functions
2167 @subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2168
2169 @cindex leaf functions
2170 @cindex functions, leaf
2171 On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2172 more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2173 means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2174 are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2175 normally arrive.
2176
2177 The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2178 other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2179 registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2180 function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2181 handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2182 functions''.
2183
2184 GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2185 suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2186 registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2187 accomplish this.
2188
2189 @defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2190 Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2191 contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2192 function treatment.
2193
2194 If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2195 registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2196 GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2197 used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2198 in this vector.
2199
2200 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2201 the treatment of leaf functions.
2202 @end defmac
2203
2204 @defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2205 A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2206 should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2207
2208 If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2209 function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2210 will cause the compiler to abort.
2211
2212 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2213 treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2214 this.
2215 @end defmac
2216
2217 @findex current_function_is_leaf
2218 @findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2219 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2220 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2221 specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2222 which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2223 set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2224 compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2225 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2226 functions which only use leaf registers.
2227 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2228 that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2229 @code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2230 @c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2231 @c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2232
2233 @node Stack Registers
2234 @subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2235
2236 There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2237 ``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2238 pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2239 stack.
2240
2241 Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2242 they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2243 support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2244 point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2245 stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2246 @file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2247 with it, as well as defining these macros.
2248
2249 @defmac STACK_REGS
2250 Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2251 @end defmac
2252
2253 @defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2254 This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2255 the machine has any stack-like registers.
2256 @end defmac
2257
2258 @defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2259 The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2260 of the stack.
2261 @end defmac
2262
2263 @defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2264 The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2265 the stack.
2266 @end defmac
2267
2268 @node Register Classes
2269 @section Register Classes
2270 @cindex register class definitions
2271 @cindex class definitions, register
2272
2273 On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2274 For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2275 certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2276 restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2277
2278 You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2279 which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2280 that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2281
2282 @findex ALL_REGS
2283 @findex NO_REGS
2284 In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2285 class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2286 class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2287 union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2288
2289 @findex GENERAL_REGS
2290 One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2291 terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2292 @samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2293 the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2294 to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2295
2296 Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2297 then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2298
2299 The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2300 constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2301 You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2302 them in operand constraints.
2303
2304 You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable
2305 registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for
2306 some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is
2307 cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory
2308 (@pxref{Costs}).
2309
2310 You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2311 instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2312 either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2313 certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2314 which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2315 or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
2316 class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
2317
2318 You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2319 classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2320 contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2321 in their union.
2322
2323 When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2324 certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2325 Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2326 a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2327 specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2328
2329 Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2330 instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2331 each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2332 mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2333 single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2334 this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2335 instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2336 single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2337 @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2338
2339 @deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2340 An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2341 as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2342 must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2343 @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2344 tells how many classes there are.
2345
2346 Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2347 the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2348 in many of the tables described below.
2349 @end deftp
2350
2351 @defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2352 The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2353
2354 @smallexample
2355 #define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2356 @end smallexample
2357 @end defmac
2358
2359 @defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2360 An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2361 constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2362 @end defmac
2363
2364 @defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2365 An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2366 which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2367 @var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2368 register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2369
2370 When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2371 Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2372 several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2373 for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2374 In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2375 registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2376 so on.
2377 @end defmac
2378
2379 @defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2380 A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2381 @var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2382 which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2383 register.
2384 @end defmac
2385
2386 @defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2387 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2388 base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2389 which is the register value plus a displacement.
2390 @end defmac
2391
2392 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2393 This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2394 the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2395 @var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2396 @code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2397 @end defmac
2398
2399 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2400 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2401 base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2402 register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2403 addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2404 @end defmac
2405
2406 @defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2407 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2408 base register for a memory reference in mode @var{mode} to address
2409 space @var{address_space} must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code}
2410 define the context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is
2411 the code of the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level
2412 of an address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2413 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2414 index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2415 @end defmac
2416
2417 @defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2418 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2419 index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2420 address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2421 added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2422 @end defmac
2423
2424 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2425 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2426 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
2427 @end defmac
2428
2429 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2430 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2431 that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2432 @var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2433 reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2434 you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2435 @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2436 addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2437 @code{address_operand}.
2438 @end defmac
2439
2440 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2441 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2442 use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2443 memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2444 pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2445 define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2446 than other base register uses.
2447
2448 Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2449 @code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2450 @end defmac
2451
2452 @defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2453 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2454 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses, accessing
2455 memory in mode @var{mode} in address space @var{address_space}.
2456 This is similar to @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2457 that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2458 appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2459 immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2460 address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2461 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2462 corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2463 @code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2464 that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
2465 @end defmac
2466
2467 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2468 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2469 suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2470 either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2471 allocated such a hard register.
2472
2473 The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2474 the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2475 two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2476 labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2477 labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2478 may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2479 looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2480 only if neither labeling works.
2481 @end defmac
2482
2483 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2484 A target hook that places additional preference on the register class to use when it is necessary to rename a register in class @var{rclass} to another class, or perhaps @var{NO_REGS}, if no preferred register class is found or hook @code{preferred_rename_class} is not implemented. Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For example, on ARM, thumb-2 instructions using @code{LO_REGS} may be smaller than instructions using @code{GENERIC_REGS}. By returning @code{LO_REGS} from @code{preferred_rename_class}, code size can be reduced.
2485 @end deftypefn
2486
2487 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2488 A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2489 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2490 @var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2491 another, smaller class.
2492
2493 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2494
2495 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2496 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2497 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2498 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2499 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2500
2501 One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2502 @var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2503 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2504 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2505 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2506 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2507 register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2508 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2509 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2510 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2511 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2512
2513 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2514 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2515 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2516 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2517 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2518 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2519 @end deftypefn
2520
2521 @defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2522 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2523 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2524 @var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2525 another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2526 safe:
2527
2528 @smallexample
2529 #define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2530 @end smallexample
2531
2532 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2533 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2534 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2535 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2536 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2537
2538 One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2539 @var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2540 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2541 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2542 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2543 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2544 register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2545 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2546 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2547 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2548 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2549
2550 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2551 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2552 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2553 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2554 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2555 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2556 @end defmac
2557
2558 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2559 Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2560 input reloads.
2561
2562 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2563 argument.
2564
2565 You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2566 reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2567 @end deftypefn
2568
2569 @defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2570 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2571 to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2572 @var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2573 ordinarily be used.
2574
2575 Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2576 there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2577
2578 The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2579 smaller class.
2580
2581 Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2582 require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2583 @end defmac
2584
2585 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD (bool @var{in_p}, rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{reload_class}, machine_mode @var{reload_mode}, secondary_reload_info *@var{sri})
2586 Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2587 from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2588 @samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2589 from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2590 term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2591 directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2592 register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2593 destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2594 source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2595 reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2596 and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2597 intermediate register still holds the required value.
2598
2599 Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2600 allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2601 register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2602 address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2603 when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2604 as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2605 that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2606 describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2607 these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2608 of the scratch register(s).
2609
2610 In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2611
2612 For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2613 and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2614 @var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2615 hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2616 needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2617
2618 If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2619 an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2620 return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2621 If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2622 If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2623 that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2624
2625 If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2626 perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2627 closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2628 required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2629 copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2630
2631 You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2632 in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2633 and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2634 for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2635 single-register-class
2636 @c [later: or memory]
2637 output constraint.
2638
2639 When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2640 hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2641 register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2642 have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2643
2644 @c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2645 @c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2646 @c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2647 @c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2648 @c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2649 @c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2650 @c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2651 @c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2652
2653
2654 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2655 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2656 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2657 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2658
2659 Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2660 currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2661 to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2662
2663 @code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2664 copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2665 (a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2666 Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2667 of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2668 forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2669 @end deftypefn
2670
2671 @defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2672 @defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2673 @defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2674 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2675 @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2676
2677 These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2678 target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2679 reload phase that it may
2680 need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2681 register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2682 register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2683 you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2684 largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2685 intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2686
2687 If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2688 intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2689 was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2690 class required. If the
2691 requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2692 @code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2693 macros identically.
2694
2695 The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2696 Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2697 can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2698 @var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2699 macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2700
2701 If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2702 intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2703 @samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2704 (@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2705 implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2706 @samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2707 register.
2708
2709 These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2710 register that
2711 contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2712 class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2713 value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2714 register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2715 Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2716
2717 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2718 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2719 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2720 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2721
2722 These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2723 registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2724 registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2725 would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2726 the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2727 intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2728 general registers.
2729 @end defmac
2730
2731 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2732 Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2733 to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2734 those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2735 @var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2736 class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2737 and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2738
2739 Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2740 @end defmac
2741
2742 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2743 Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2744 allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2745 If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2746 defined by this macro.
2747
2748 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2749 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2750 @end defmac
2751
2752 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2753 When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2754 registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2755 hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2756 load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2757 same as that of @var{mode}.
2758
2759 This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2760 bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2761 in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2762 registers.
2763
2764 However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2765 the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2766 differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2767 widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2768 suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2769 details.
2770
2771 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2772 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2773 is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2774 @end defmac
2775
2776 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2777 A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2778 to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2779 registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2780
2781 The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2782 has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2783 default should be used. For generally register-starved machines, such as
2784 i386, or machines with right register constraints, such as SH, this hook
2785 can be used to avoid excessive spilling.
2786
2787 This hook is also used by some of the global intra-procedural code
2788 transformations to throtle code motion, to avoid increasing register
2789 pressure.
2790 @end deftypefn
2791
2792 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (reg_class_t @var{rclass}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2793 A target hook returns the maximum number of consecutive registers
2794 of class @var{rclass} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2795
2796 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2797 the value returned by @code{TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{rclass},
2798 @var{mode})} target hook should be the maximum value of
2799 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})} for all @var{regno}
2800 values in the class @var{rclass}.
2801
2802 This target hook helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2803 in the reload pass.
2804
2805 The default version of this target hook returns the size of @var{mode}
2806 in words.
2807 @end deftypefn
2808
2809 @defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2810 A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2811 of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2812
2813 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2814 the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2815 should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2816 @var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2817
2818 This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2819 in the reload pass.
2820 @end defmac
2821
2822 @defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2823 If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2824 a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2825
2826 For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2827 floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2828 Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2829 does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2830 register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2831 as below:
2832
2833 @smallexample
2834 #define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2835 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2836 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2837 @end smallexample
2838 @end defmac
2839
2840 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_IRA_CHANGE_PSEUDO_ALLOCNO_CLASS (int, @var{reg_class_t})
2841 A target hook which can change allocno class for given pseudo from
2842 allocno class calculated by IRA.
2843
2844 The default version of this target hook always returns given class.
2845 @end deftypefn
2846
2847 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LRA_P (void)
2848 A target hook which returns true if we use LRA instead of reload pass. It means that LRA was ported to the target. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2849 @end deftypefn
2850
2851 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_PRIORITY (int)
2852 A target hook which returns the register priority number to which the register @var{hard_regno} belongs to. The bigger the number, the more preferable the hard register usage (when all other conditions are the same). This hook can be used to prefer some hard register over others in LRA. For example, some x86-64 register usage needs additional prefix which makes instructions longer. The hook can return lower priority number for such registers make them less favorable and as result making the generated code smaller. The default version of this target hook returns always zero.
2853 @end deftypefn
2854
2855 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REGISTER_USAGE_LEVELING_P (void)
2856 A target hook which returns true if we need register usage leveling. That means if a few hard registers are equally good for the assignment, we choose the least used hard register. The register usage leveling may be profitable for some targets. Don't use the usage leveling for targets with conditional execution or targets with big register files as it hurts if-conversion and cross-jumping optimizations. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2857 @end deftypefn
2858
2859 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DIFFERENT_ADDR_DISPLACEMENT_P (void)
2860 A target hook which returns true if an address with the same structure can have different maximal legitimate displacement. For example, the displacement can depend on memory mode or on operand combinations in the insn. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2861 @end deftypefn
2862
2863 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_SUBSTITUTE_MEM_EQUIV_P (rtx @var{subst})
2864 A target hook which returns @code{true} if @var{subst} can't
2865 substitute safely pseudos with equivalent memory values during
2866 register allocation.
2867 The default version of this target hook returns @code{false}.
2868 On most machines, this default should be used. For generally
2869 machines with non orthogonal register usage for addressing, such
2870 as SH, this hook can be used to avoid excessive spilling.
2871 @end deftypefn
2872
2873 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS_DISPLACEMENT (rtx *@var{disp}, rtx *@var{offset}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2874 A target hook which returns @code{true} if *@var{disp} is
2875 legitimezed to valid address displacement with subtracting *@var{offset}
2876 at memory mode @var{mode}.
2877 The default version of this target hook returns @code{false}.
2878 This hook will benefit machines with limited base plus displacement
2879 addressing.
2880 @end deftypefn
2881
2882 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SPILL_CLASS (reg_class_t, @var{machine_mode})
2883 This hook defines a class of registers which could be used for spilling pseudos of the given mode and class, or @code{NO_REGS} if only memory should be used. Not defining this hook is equivalent to returning @code{NO_REGS} for all inputs.
2884 @end deftypefn
2885
2886 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_CSTORE_MODE (enum insn_code @var{icode})
2887 This hook defines the machine mode to use for the boolean result of conditional store patterns. The ICODE argument is the instruction code for the cstore being performed. Not definiting this hook is the same as accepting the mode encoded into operand 0 of the cstore expander patterns.
2888 @end deftypefn
2889
2890 @node Stack and Calling
2891 @section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
2892 @cindex calling conventions
2893
2894 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2895 This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
2896
2897 @menu
2898 * Frame Layout::
2899 * Exception Handling::
2900 * Stack Checking::
2901 * Frame Registers::
2902 * Elimination::
2903 * Stack Arguments::
2904 * Register Arguments::
2905 * Scalar Return::
2906 * Aggregate Return::
2907 * Caller Saves::
2908 * Function Entry::
2909 * Profiling::
2910 * Tail Calls::
2911 * Stack Smashing Protection::
2912 * Miscellaneous Register Hooks::
2913 @end menu
2914
2915 @node Frame Layout
2916 @subsection Basic Stack Layout
2917 @cindex stack frame layout
2918 @cindex frame layout
2919
2920 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2921 Here is the basic stack layout.
2922
2923 @defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2924 Define this macro to be true if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
2925 pointer to a smaller address, and false otherwise.
2926 @end defmac
2927
2928 @defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
2929 This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
2930 on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
2931 @code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
2932
2933 The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
2934 and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
2935 the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
2936 to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
2937 space for the next item on the stack.
2938
2939 The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
2940 true, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
2941 which is often wrong.
2942 @end defmac
2943
2944 @defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2945 Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
2946 are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
2947 @end defmac
2948
2949 @defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
2950 Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
2951 addresses on the stack.
2952 @end defmac
2953
2954 @defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
2955 Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
2956
2957 If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
2958 subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2959 Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
2960 value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2961 @c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
2962 @c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
2963 @end defmac
2964
2965 @defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
2966 Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
2967 The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
2968
2969 On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
2970 is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
2971 alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
2972 stack alignment and do it in the backend.
2973 @end defmac
2974
2975 @defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
2976 Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
2977 outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
2978 zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
2979
2980 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
2981 the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
2982 @end defmac
2983
2984 @defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
2985 Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
2986 address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
2987 function.
2988
2989 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
2990 the first argument's address.
2991 @end defmac
2992
2993 @defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
2994 Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
2995 on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
2996
2997 The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
2998 length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
2999 machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3000 @end defmac
3001
3002 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3003 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3004 stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3005 @code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3006 default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3007 elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3008 @code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3009 @end defmac
3010
3011 @defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3012 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3013 frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3014 @var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3015 itself.
3016
3017 If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3018 of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3019 address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3020 @end defmac
3021
3022 @defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3023 If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3024 setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3025 on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3026 before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3027 define this macro.
3028 @end defmac
3029
3030 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE (void)
3031 This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3032 the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3033 The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3034 machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3035 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3036 @end deftypefn
3037
3038 @defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3039 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3040 address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3041 of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3042 You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3043 as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3044 @end defmac
3045
3046 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3047 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3048 address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3049 the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3050 frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3051 @code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is nonzero.
3052
3053 The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3054 @var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3055 determine the return address of other frames.
3056 @end defmac
3057
3058 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3059 Define this macro to nonzero value if the return address of a particular
3060 stack frame is accessed from the frame pointer of the previous stack
3061 frame. The zero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3062 @end defmac
3063
3064 @defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3065 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3066 incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3067 prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3068 value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3069 the stack.
3070
3071 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3072 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3073
3074 If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3075 @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3076 @end defmac
3077
3078 @defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3079 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3080 number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3081 must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3082 be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3083
3084 This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3085 general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3086 frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3087 over time.
3088 @end defmac
3089
3090 @defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3091 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3092 number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3093 only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3094 someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3095 terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3096 @end defmac
3097
3098 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC (const char *@var{label}, rtx @var{pattern}, int @var{index})
3099 This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3100 contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3101 info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3102 @smallexample
3103 (set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3104 @end smallexample
3105 and
3106 @smallexample
3107 (set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3108 @end smallexample
3109 to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3110 the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3111 the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3112 @end deftypefn
3113
3114 @defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3115 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3116 from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3117 frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3118 the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3119 previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3120
3121 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3122 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3123 @end defmac
3124
3125 @defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3126 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3127 from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3128 final value should coincide with that calculated by
3129 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3130 during virtual register instantiation.
3131
3132 The default value for this macro is
3133 @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3134 which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3135 immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3136 some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3137 and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3138
3139 You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3140 want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3141 DWARF 2.
3142 @end defmac
3143
3144 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3145 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3146 in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3147 The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3148 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3149
3150 Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3151 via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3152 variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3153 defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3154 based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3155 of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3156 should be defined.
3157 @end defmac
3158
3159 @defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3160 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3161 in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3162 in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3163 may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3164 @end defmac
3165
3166 @node Exception Handling
3167 @subsection Exception Handling Support
3168 @cindex exception handling
3169
3170 @defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3171 A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3172 data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3173 @var{N} registers are usable.
3174
3175 The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3176 handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3177 should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3178 but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
3179 2 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3180
3181 You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3182 handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3183 @end defmac
3184
3185 @defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3186 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3187 to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3188 This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3189 It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3190
3191 Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3192 untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3193
3194 Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3195 by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3196 this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3197 stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3198 this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3199 that provided by DWARF 2.
3200 @end defmac
3201
3202 @defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3203 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3204 to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3205 return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3206
3207 Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3208 return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3209 address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3210 the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3211 frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3212 been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3213 target call frame.
3214
3215 Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3216 address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3217 the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3218
3219 If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3220 define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3221 @end defmac
3222
3223 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3224 If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3225 to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3226 exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3227 using it to return to the exception handler.
3228 @end defmac
3229
3230 @defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3231 This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3232 handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3233 that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3234 and so may be read-only.
3235
3236 @var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3237 @var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3238 The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3239 as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3240
3241 If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3242 represented directly.
3243 @end defmac
3244
3245 @defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3246 This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3247 to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3248 Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3249 be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3250
3251 This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3252 handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3253 of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3254 to be emitted.
3255 @end defmac
3256
3257 @defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3258 This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3259 code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3260 available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3261 through signal frames.
3262
3263 This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3264 @file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3265 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3266 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3267 for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3268 the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3269 save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3270 evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3271 the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3272
3273 For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3274 @code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3275 @end defmac
3276
3277 @defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3278 This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3279 call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3280 usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3281
3282 This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in libgcc's
3283 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3284 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3285 for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3286 @code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3287 be updated in @var{fs}.
3288 @end defmac
3289
3290 @defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3291 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3292 info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3293 linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3294 @end defmac
3295
3296 @node Stack Checking
3297 @subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3298
3299 GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3300 stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3301 three ways:
3302
3303 @enumerate
3304 @item
3305 If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3306 will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3307 at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3308 other special processing.
3309
3310 @item
3311 If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3312 @code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3313 that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3314 static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3315 in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3316 stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3317 approach below.
3318
3319 @item
3320 If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3321 ``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3322 @end enumerate
3323
3324 If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3325 GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3326 @option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3327 dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3328
3329 @defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3330 A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3331 machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3332 is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3333 checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3334 value of this macro is zero.
3335 @end defmac
3336
3337 @defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3338 A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3339 in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3340 like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3341 approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3342 @end defmac
3343
3344 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3345 An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3346 instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3347 define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3348 the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3349 of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3350 @end defmac
3351
3352 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3353 An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3354 when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3355 contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3356 thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3357 is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3358 default value of this macro is zero.
3359 @end defmac
3360
3361 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3362 The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3363 languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 75 words
3364 with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
3365 8192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3366 most machines.
3367 @end defmac
3368
3369 The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3370 nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3371 in the opposite case.
3372
3373 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3374 The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3375 instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3376 stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3377 checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3378 default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3379 systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3380 @end defmac
3381
3382 @defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3383 GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3384 represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3385 space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3386 You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3387 use the default of four words.
3388 @end defmac
3389
3390 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3391 The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3392 fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3393 @option{-fstack-check}.
3394 GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3395 normally not need to override that default.
3396 @end defmac
3397
3398 @need 2000
3399 @node Frame Registers
3400 @subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3401
3402 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3403 This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3404
3405 @defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3406 The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3407 fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3408 the hardware determines which register this is.
3409 @end defmac
3410
3411 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3412 The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3413 access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3414 hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3415 choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3416 @end defmac
3417
3418 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3419 On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3420 offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3421 allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3422 between these two locations). On those machines, define
3423 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3424 be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3425 @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3426 used for the frame pointer.
3427
3428 You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3429 is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3430 the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3431 completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3432 definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3433 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3434 or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3435
3436 Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3437 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3438 @end defmac
3439
3440 @defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3441 The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3442 the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3443 frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3444 register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3445 wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3446 pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3447 @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3448 (@pxref{Elimination}).
3449 @end defmac
3450
3451 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3452 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3453 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3454 the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3455 == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3456 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3457 @end defmac
3458
3459 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3460 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3461 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3462 same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3463 ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3464 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3465 @end defmac
3466
3467 @defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3468 The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3469 access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3470 machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3471 pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3472 to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3473 @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3474
3475 Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3476 address from the stack.
3477 @end defmac
3478
3479 @defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3480 @defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3481 Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3482 register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3483 function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3484 number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3485 these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3486 not be defined.
3487
3488 The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3489
3490 If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3491 defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3492 @end defmac
3493
3494 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN (const_tree @var{fndecl_or_type}, bool @var{incoming_p})
3495 This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3496 targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3497 nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3498 attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3499 those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3500
3501 The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3502
3503 If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3504 provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3505 Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3506 from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3507 will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3508 @findex stack_pointer_rtx
3509 @findex frame_pointer_rtx
3510 @findex arg_pointer_rtx
3511 The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3512 @code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3513 to refer to those items.
3514 @end deftypefn
3515
3516 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3517 This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3518 saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3519 DWARF2 exception handling.
3520
3521 Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3522 exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3523 extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3524 in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3525 used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3526 routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3527 registers that are not call-saved.
3528
3529 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3530 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3531 @end defmac
3532
3533 @defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3534
3535 This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3536 for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3537
3538 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3539 @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3540 @end defmac
3541
3542 @defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3543
3544 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3545 is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3546 Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3547 column number to use instead.
3548
3549 See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3550 @end defmac
3551
3552 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3553
3554 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3555 used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3556 debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3557 should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3558 @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3559
3560 @end defmac
3561
3562 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3563
3564 Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3565 that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3566 should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3567 .eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3568 return @code{@var{regno}}.
3569
3570 @end defmac
3571
3572 @defmac REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3573
3574 Define this macro if the target stores register values as
3575 @code{_Unwind_Word} type in unwind context. It should be defined if
3576 target register size is larger than the size of @code{void *}. The
3577 default is to store register values as @code{void *} type.
3578
3579 @end defmac
3580
3581 @defmac ASSUME_EXTENDED_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3582
3583 Define this macro to be 1 if the target always uses extended unwind
3584 context with version, args_size and by_value fields. If it is undefined,
3585 it will be defined to 1 when @code{REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT} is
3586 defined and 0 otherwise.
3587
3588 @end defmac
3589
3590 @node Elimination
3591 @subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3592
3593 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3594 This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3595
3596 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED (void)
3597 This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3598 a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3599 value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3600
3601 This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3602 according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3603 constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3604 to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3605 Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3606 pointer.
3607
3608 In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3609 without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3610 automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3611 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
3612 them.
3613
3614 In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3615 register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3616 fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3617
3618 Default return value is @code{false}.
3619 @end deftypefn
3620
3621 @findex get_frame_size
3622 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3623 A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3624 between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3625 the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3626 such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3627 registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3628
3629 If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3630 need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3631 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
3632 case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3633 @end defmac
3634
3635 @defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3636 If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3637 eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3638 defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3639 references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3640
3641 The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3642 of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3643
3644 On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3645 the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3646 must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3647 replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3648 depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3649
3650 In this case, you might specify:
3651 @smallexample
3652 #define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3653 @{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3654 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3655 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3656 @end smallexample
3657
3658 Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3659 specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3660 @end defmac
3661
3662 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE (const int @var{from_reg}, const int @var{to_reg})
3663 This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3664 try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3665 @var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3666 is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
3667 preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3668 knows about.
3669
3670 Default return value is @code{true}.
3671 @end deftypefn
3672
3673 @defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3674 This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3675 specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3676 registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3677 defined.
3678 @end defmac
3679
3680 @node Stack Arguments
3681 @subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3682 @cindex arguments on stack
3683 @cindex stack arguments
3684
3685 The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3686 on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3687 control passing certain arguments in registers.
3688
3689 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES (const_tree @var{fntype})
3690 This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3691 prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3692 passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3693 cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3694 The default is to not promote prototypes.
3695 @end deftypefn
3696
3697 @defmac PUSH_ARGS
3698 A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3699 outgoing arguments.
3700 If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3701 That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3702 allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3703 it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3704 @end defmac
3705
3706 @defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3707 A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3708 last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3709 defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3710 and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3711 @end defmac
3712
3713 @defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3714 A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3715 stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3716
3717 On some machines, the definition
3718
3719 @smallexample
3720 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3721 @end smallexample
3722
3723 @noindent
3724 will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3725 to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3726 alignment. Then the definition should be
3727
3728 @smallexample
3729 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3730 @end smallexample
3731
3732 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
3733 @end defmac
3734
3735 @findex outgoing_args_size
3736 @findex crtl->outgoing_args_size
3737 @defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3738 A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3739 will be computed and placed into
3740 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3741 onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3742 increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3743
3744 Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3745 is not proper.
3746 @end defmac
3747
3748 @defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3749 Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3750 allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3751 registers.
3752
3753 The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3754 arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3755 which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3756 The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3757 of the function.
3758
3759 This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3760 machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3761 which.
3762 @end defmac
3763 @c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3764 @c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3765
3766 @defmac INCOMING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3767 Like @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, but for incoming register arguments.
3768 Define this macro if space guaranteed when compiling a function body
3769 is different to space required when making a call, a situation that
3770 can arise with K&R style function definitions.
3771 @end defmac
3772
3773 @defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3774 Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3775 caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3776 when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3777 if the function called is a library function.
3778
3779 If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3780 whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3781 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}.
3782 @end defmac
3783
3784 @defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3785 Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3786 stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3787 @c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3788 @c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3789
3790 Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3791 stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3792 suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3793 stack in its natural location.
3794 @end defmac
3795
3796 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS (tree @var{fundecl}, tree @var{funtype}, int @var{size})
3797 This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3798 a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3799 and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3800
3801 @var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3802 the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3803 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3804 From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3805
3806 @var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3807 describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3808 @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3809 From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3810 arguments (if known).
3811
3812 When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3813 will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3814 you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3815 by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3816 a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3817 in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3818
3819 @var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3820 stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3821 argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3822
3823 On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3824 of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
3825 calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3826 the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3827 convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3828 arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3829 nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3830 @var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3831 number of arguments.
3832 @end deftypefn
3833
3834 @defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3835 A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3836 pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3837 when compiling a function call.
3838
3839 @var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3840 have been accumulated.
3841
3842 On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3843 that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3844 that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3845 call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3846 appropriate.
3847 @end defmac
3848
3849 @node Register Arguments
3850 @subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3851 @cindex arguments in registers
3852 @cindex registers arguments
3853
3854 This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3855 types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3856 the stack.
3857
3858 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3859 Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a
3860 register and if so, which register.
3861
3862 The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous
3863 arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3864 the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3865 (which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
3866 which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for
3867 nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called
3868 function's prototype. @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a
3869 syntax error has previously occurred.
3870
3871 The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3872 register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
3873 on the stack.
3874
3875 The return value can be a @code{const_int} which means argument is
3876 passed in a target specific slot with specified number. Target hooks
3877 should be used to store or load argument in such case. See
3878 @code{TARGET_STORE_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG} and @code{TARGET_LOAD_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG}
3879 for more information.
3880
3881 The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
3882 used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
3883 @code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
3884 @code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
3885 describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
3886 @code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3887 register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3888 register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
3889 second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3890 the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
3891 As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
3892 RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
3893 argument is also stored on the stack.
3894
3895 The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
3896 VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
3897 pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
3898
3899 @cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
3900 The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
3901 machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
3902 cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is
3903 done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
3904 @var{named} is @code{false}.
3905
3906 @cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
3907 @cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
3908 You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
3909 in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
3910 type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
3911 is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
3912 argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
3913 defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
3914 a register.
3915 @end deftypefn
3916
3917 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
3918 This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
3919 solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
3920 definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
3921 documentation.
3922 @end deftypefn
3923
3924 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3925 Define this hook if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
3926 that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
3927 necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
3928 argument.
3929
3930 For such machines, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
3931 which the caller passes the value, and
3932 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
3933 fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
3934 arrive.
3935
3936 If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
3937 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
3938 @end deftypefn
3939
3940 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_PSEUDO_PIC_REG (void)
3941 This hook should return 1 in case pseudo register should be created
3942 for pic_offset_table_rtx during function expand.
3943 @end deftypefn
3944
3945 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_PIC_REG (void)
3946 Perform a target dependent initialization of pic_offset_table_rtx.
3947 This hook is called at the start of register allocation.
3948 @end deftypefn
3949
3950 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3951 This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
3952 argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
3953 arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
3954 pushed on the stack.
3955
3956 On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
3957 registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
3958 first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
3959 on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
3960 structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
3961 in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
3962 compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
3963
3964 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
3965 register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
3966 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
3967 @end deftypefn
3968
3969 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3970 This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
3971 position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
3972 predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
3973 passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
3974
3975 If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
3976 pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
3977 The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
3978 to that type.
3979 @end deftypefn
3980
3981 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3982 The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
3983 known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
3984 function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
3985 by the caller.
3986
3987 For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
3988 determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
3989 not be generated.
3990
3991 The default version of this hook always returns false.
3992 @end deftypefn
3993
3994 @defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
3995 A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
3996 of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some
3997 target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
3998 of bytes of argument so far.
3999
4000 There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4001 arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4002 variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4003 arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4004 @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4005 should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4006 @end defmac
4007
4008 @defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4009 If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4010 function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4011 created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4012 reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4013 If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4014 @var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4015 @end defmac
4016
4017 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4018 A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4019 @var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4020 variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4021 is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4022 the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4023 For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4024 declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4025 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4026 being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4027 arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4028 parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4029 @var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4030
4031 When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4032 @var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4033 contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4034 an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4035 macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4036 never both of them at once.
4037 @end defmac
4038
4039 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4040 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4041 it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4042 @code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4043 is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
4044 0)} is used instead.
4045 @end defmac
4046
4047 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4048 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4049 finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4050 undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4051
4052 The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4053 with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4054 argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4055 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4056 @c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4057 @c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4058 @end defmac
4059
4060 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4061 This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4062 advance past an argument in the argument list. The values @var{mode},
4063 @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument. Once this is done,
4064 the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4065 argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
4066
4067 This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4068 on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4069 used for arguments without any special help.
4070 @end deftypefn
4071
4072 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4073 If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4074 offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4075 which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4076 slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4077 top.
4078 @end defmac
4079
4080 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4081 If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4082 to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4083 @code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4084 @code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4085
4086 The @emph{amount} of padding is not controlled by this macro, but by the
4087 target hook @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY}. It is
4088 always just enough to reach the next multiple of that boundary.
4089
4090 This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4091 For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4092 big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4093 constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4094 @end defmac
4095
4096 @defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4097 If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4098 implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4099 next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4100 controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4101 arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4102 @end defmac
4103
4104 @defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4105 Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4106 memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4107 macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4108 machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4109 @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4110 registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4111 a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4112 required.
4113 @end defmac
4114
4115 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4116 This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
4117 with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4118 @code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4119 @end deftypefn
4120
4121 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4122 Normally, the size of an argument is rounded up to @code{PARM_BOUNDARY},
4123 which is the default value for this hook. You can define this hook to
4124 return a different value if an argument size must be rounded to a larger
4125 value.
4126 @end deftypefn
4127
4128 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4129 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4130 register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4131 @emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4132 the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4133 used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4134 stack.
4135 @end defmac
4136
4137 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG (const_tree @var{type})
4138 This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4139 as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4140 arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4141 to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4142 AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4143 registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4144 point register.
4145
4146 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4147 false.
4148 @end deftypefn
4149
4150 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST (void)
4151 This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4152 The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4153 @end deftypefn
4154
4155 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P (int @var{idx}, const char **@var{pname}, tree *@var{ptree})
4156 This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4157 to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4158 variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
4159 to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
4160 variable.
4161 The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
4162 this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4163 internal type.
4164 If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4165 Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4166 macro to iterate through all types.
4167 @end deftypefn
4168
4169 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST (tree @var{fndecl})
4170 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4171 @var{fndecl}.
4172 The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4173 @end deftypefn
4174
4175 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE (tree @var{type})
4176 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4177 type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4178 @code{NULL_TREE}.
4179 @end deftypefn
4180
4181 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR (tree @var{valist}, tree @var{type}, gimple_seq *@var{pre_p}, gimple_seq *@var{post_p})
4182 This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4183 @code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4184 arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4185 @code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4186 @end deftypefn
4187
4188 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
4189 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4190 with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4191 hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4192 @end deftypefn
4193
4194 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO (struct ao_ref *@var{ref})
4195 Define this to return nonzero if the memory reference @var{ref} may alias with the system C library errno location. The default version of this hook assumes the system C library errno location is either a declaration of type int or accessed by dereferencing a pointer to int.
4196 @end deftypefn
4197
4198 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4199 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4200 insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4201 considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4202 must work.
4203
4204 The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4205 required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4206 Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4207 code in @file{optabs.c}.
4208 @end deftypefn
4209
4210 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4211 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4212 insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4213 must have move patterns for this mode.
4214 @end deftypefn
4215
4216 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{nelems})
4217 Return true if GCC should try to use a scalar mode to store an array
4218 of @var{nelems} elements, given that each element has mode @var{mode}.
4219 Returning true here overrides the usual @code{MAX_FIXED_MODE} limit
4220 and allows GCC to use any defined integer mode.
4221
4222 One use of this hook is to support vector load and store operations
4223 that operate on several homogeneous vectors. For example, ARM NEON
4224 has operations like:
4225
4226 @smallexample
4227 int8x8x3_t vld3_s8 (const int8_t *)
4228 @end smallexample
4229
4230 where the return type is defined as:
4231
4232 @smallexample
4233 typedef struct int8x8x3_t
4234 @{
4235 int8x8_t val[3];
4236 @} int8x8x3_t;
4237 @end smallexample
4238
4239 If this hook allows @code{val} to have a scalar mode, then
4240 @code{int8x8x3_t} can have the same mode. GCC can then store
4241 @code{int8x8x3_t}s in registers rather than forcing them onto the stack.
4242 @end deftypefn
4243
4244 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBGCC_FLOATING_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4245 Define this to return nonzero if libgcc provides support for the
4246 floating-point mode @var{mode}, which is known to pass
4247 @code{TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P}. The default version of this
4248 hook returns true for all of @code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode},
4249 @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode}, if such modes exist.
4250 @end deftypefn
4251
4252 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4253 Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4254 small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4255 @var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4256 in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4257 In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4258 for any mode.
4259
4260 On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4261 insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4262 to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4263 if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4264 insn.
4265
4266 Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4267 in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4268 the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4269 classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4270 registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4271 registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4272 SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4273 strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4274 machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4275
4276 The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always
4277 safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4278 unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4279 that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4280 to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4281 of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4282 @end deftypefn
4283
4284 @node Scalar Return
4285 @subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4286 @cindex return values in registers
4287 @cindex values, returned by functions
4288 @cindex scalars, returned as values
4289
4290 This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4291 values---values that can fit in registers.
4292
4293 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
4294
4295 Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4296 returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4297 representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4298 representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4299 function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4300 compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4301 Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4302 a function returns a value.
4303
4304 On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4305 (Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4306 place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4307 @code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4308 The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4309 multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4310 @code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4311 location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4312 the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4313 that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4314 port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4315 @samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4316
4317 If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4318 the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4319 @var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4320
4321 If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4322 node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4323 pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4324 convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4325 known.
4326
4327 Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4328 which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4329 the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4330 different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4331
4332 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4333 aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4334 @code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4335 @end deftypefn
4336
4337 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4338 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4339 a new target instead.
4340 @end defmac
4341
4342 @defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4343 A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4344 function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4345
4346 Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4347 support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4348 specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4349 compiled.
4350 @end defmac
4351
4352 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{fun})
4353 Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4354 function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4355
4356 The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4357 library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
4358 representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4359
4360 If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4361 @end deftypefn
4362
4363 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4364 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4365 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4366
4367 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4368 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4369 recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4370 suffices:
4371
4372 @smallexample
4373 #define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4374 @end smallexample
4375
4376 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4377 function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4378 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4379
4380 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4381 for a new target instead.
4382 @end defmac
4383
4384 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (const unsigned int @var{regno})
4385 A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4386 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4387
4388 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4389 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4390 recognized by this target hook.
4391
4392 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4393 function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4394 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4395
4396 If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4397 @end deftypefn
4398
4399 @defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4400 Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4401 need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4402 saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4403 @end defmac
4404
4405 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OMIT_STRUCT_RETURN_REG
4406 Normally, when a function returns a structure by memory, the address
4407 is passed as an invisible pointer argument, but the compiler also
4408 arranges to return the address from the function like it would a normal
4409 pointer return value. Define this to true if that behaviour is
4410 undesirable on your target.
4411 @end deftypevr
4412
4413 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB (const_tree @var{type})
4414 This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4415 at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4416 padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4417 is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4418
4419 Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4420 be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4421 or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
4422 4-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4423 @code{SImode} rtx.
4424 @end deftypefn
4425
4426 @node Aggregate Return
4427 @subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4428 @cindex aggregates as return values
4429 @cindex large return values
4430 @cindex returning aggregate values
4431 @cindex structure value address
4432
4433 When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4434 cases), the value is not returned according to
4435 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4436 caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4437 should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4438 address}.
4439
4440 This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4441 memory.
4442
4443 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY (const_tree @var{type}, const_tree @var{fntype})
4444 This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4445 function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4446 Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4447 will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4448 libcalls.
4449
4450 Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4451 by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4452 takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4453 possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4454 definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4455 values, and 0 otherwise.
4456
4457 Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4458 be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4459 to indicate this.
4460 @end deftypefn
4461
4462 @defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4463 Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4464 in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4465 only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4466 If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4467 and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4468 target hook.
4469
4470 If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4471 @end defmac
4472
4473 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{incoming})
4474 This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4475 address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4476 passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4477 be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4478 hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4479 argument.
4480
4481 On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4482 is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4483 caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4484 be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4485 @var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4486 the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4487 the caller.
4488
4489 If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4490 stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4491 @var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4492 structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4493 to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4494 @end deftypefn
4495
4496 @defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4497 Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4498 for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4499 the address of a static variable containing the value.
4500
4501 Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4502 pass an address to the subroutine.
4503
4504 This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4505 nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4506 @end defmac
4507
4508 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE (int @var{regno})
4509 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw return registers in @code{__builtin_return}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4510 @end deftypefn
4511
4512 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE (int @var{regno})
4513 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw argument registers in @code{__builtin_apply_args}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4514 @end deftypefn
4515
4516 @node Caller Saves
4517 @subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4518
4519 If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4520 makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4521 must live across calls.
4522
4523 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4524 A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4525 of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4526 @var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4527 returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4528 will select the smallest suitable mode.
4529 @end defmac
4530
4531 @node Function Entry
4532 @subsection Function Entry and Exit
4533 @cindex function entry and exit
4534 @cindex prologue
4535 @cindex epilogue
4536
4537 This section describes the macros that output function entry
4538 (@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4539
4540 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4541 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4542 function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4543 initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4544 saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4545 local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4546 stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4547
4548 The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4549 macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4550
4551 @findex regs_ever_live
4552 To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4553 @code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4554 @var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4555 prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4556 call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4557 @code{regs_ever_live}.)
4558
4559 On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4560 not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4561 they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4562 appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4563 registers are used in the function.
4564
4565 @findex frame_pointer_needed
4566 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4567 function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4568 pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4569 frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4570 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4571 time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4572
4573 The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4574 required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4575 listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4576 order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4577 stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4578 the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4579 for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4580 compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4581 or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4582 need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4583 @end deftypefn
4584
4585 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4586 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4587 prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4588 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4589 emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4590 @end deftypefn
4591
4592 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4593 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4594 epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4595 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4596 emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4597 @end deftypefn
4598
4599 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4600 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4601 function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4602 registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4603 called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4604 same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4605 registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4606 @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4607
4608 On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4609 of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4610 instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4611 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4612
4613 Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4614 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4615 switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4616 define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4617 target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4618 condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4619
4620 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4621 function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4622 two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4623 is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4624 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4625 a function that needs a frame pointer.
4626
4627 Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4628 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4629 The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4630 function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4631
4632 On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4633 others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4634 given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4635 number of arguments.
4636
4637 @findex pops_args
4638 @findex crtl->args.pops_args
4639 Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4640 functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4641 needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4642 function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4643 @code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4644 @end deftypefn
4645
4646 @itemize @bullet
4647 @item
4648 @findex pretend_args_size
4649 @findex crtl->args.pretend_args_size
4650 A region of @code{crtl->args.pretend_args_size} bytes of
4651 uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4652 stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4653 if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4654 arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4655 yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4656 region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4657 registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4658 features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4659
4660 @item
4661 An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4662 The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4663 the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4664 machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4665 in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4666 a save area.
4667
4668 @item
4669 A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4670 boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4671 this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4672 save area closer to the top of the stack.
4673
4674 @item
4675 @cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4676 Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4677 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4678 argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4679 @end itemize
4680
4681 @defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4682 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4683 instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4684 pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4685 adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4686 default is 0.
4687
4688 Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4689 frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4690 stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4691 compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4692 @end defmac
4693
4694 @defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4695 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4696 used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4697 pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4698 @end defmac
4699
4700 @defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4701 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4702 used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4703 on entry to an exception edge.
4704 @end defmac
4705
4706 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
4707 A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4708 function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4709 inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4710 adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4711 the real function.
4712
4713 First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4714 contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4715 contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4716 in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4717 e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4718 all other incoming arguments.
4719
4720 Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4721 made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4722 adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4723
4724 @smallexample
4725 p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4726 @end smallexample
4727
4728 After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4729 @code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4730 not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4731 return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4732
4733 The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4734 the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4735 of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4736 and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4737
4738 The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4739 have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4740 some targets, but probably not.
4741
4742 If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4743 front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4744 @var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4745 not support varargs.
4746 @end deftypefn
4747
4748 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (const_tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, const_tree @var{function})
4749 A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4750 to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4751 arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4752 generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4753 previously exposed.
4754 @end deftypefn
4755
4756 @node Profiling
4757 @subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4758 @cindex profiling, code generation
4759
4760 These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4761
4762 @defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4763 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4764 assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4765
4766 @findex mcount
4767 The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4768 your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4769 compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4770 compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4771
4772 Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4773 variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4774 @samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4775 the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4776 @end defmac
4777
4778 @defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4779 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4780 code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4781 not support profiling.
4782 @end defmac
4783
4784 @defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4785 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4786 @code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4787 allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4788 implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4789 @var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4790 @end defmac
4791
4792 @defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4793 Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4794 the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4795 @end defmac
4796
4797 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_KEEP_LEAF_WHEN_PROFILED (void)
4798 This target hook returns true if the target wants the leaf flag for the current function to stay true even if it calls mcount. This might make sense for targets using the leaf flag only to determine whether a stack frame needs to be generated or not and for which the call to mcount is generated before the function prologue.
4799 @end deftypefn
4800
4801 @node Tail Calls
4802 @subsection Permitting tail calls
4803 @cindex tail calls
4804
4805 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp})
4806 True if it is OK to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4807 call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4808 or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4809
4810 It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4811 tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4812 during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4813 as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4814 ``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4815 may vary greatly between different architectures.
4816 @end deftypefn
4817
4818 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY (bitmap @var{regs})
4819 Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4820 function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4821 cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4822 registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4823 TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4824 FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4825 @end deftypefn
4826
4827 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_UP_BY_PROLOGUE (struct hard_reg_set_container *@var{})
4828 This hook should add additional registers that are computed by the prologue to the hard regset for shrink-wrapping optimization purposes.
4829 @end deftypefn
4830
4831 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WARN_FUNC_RETURN (tree)
4832 True if a function's return statements should be checked for matching the function's return type. This includes checking for falling off the end of a non-void function. Return false if no such check should be made.
4833 @end deftypefn
4834
4835 @node Stack Smashing Protection
4836 @subsection Stack smashing protection
4837 @cindex stack smashing protection
4838
4839 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD (void)
4840 This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4841 for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
4842 runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4843 that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4844 variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4845
4846 The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4847 @samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4848 @end deftypefn
4849
4850 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL (void)
4851 This hook returns a @code{CALL_EXPR} that alerts the runtime that the
4852 stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
4853 involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4854
4855 The default version of this hook invokes a function called
4856 @samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
4857 normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4858 @end deftypefn
4859
4860 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK (bool @var{report}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
4861 Whether this target supports splitting the stack when the options described in @var{opts} have been passed. This is called after options have been parsed, so the target may reject splitting the stack in some configurations. The default version of this hook returns false. If @var{report} is true, this function may issue a warning or error; if @var{report} is false, it must simply return a value
4862 @end deftypefn
4863
4864 @node Miscellaneous Register Hooks
4865 @subsection Miscellaneous register hooks
4866 @cindex miscellaneous register hooks
4867
4868 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALL_FUSAGE_CONTAINS_NON_CALLEE_CLOBBERS
4869 Set to true if each call that binds to a local definition explicitly
4870 clobbers or sets all non-fixed registers modified by performing the call.
4871 That is, by the call pattern itself, or by code that might be inserted by the
4872 linker (e.g. stubs, veneers, branch islands), but not including those
4873 modifiable by the callee. The affected registers may be mentioned explicitly
4874 in the call pattern, or included as clobbers in CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE.
4875 The default version of this hook is set to false. The purpose of this hook
4876 is to enable the fipa-ra optimization.
4877 @end deftypevr
4878
4879 @node Varargs
4880 @section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4881 @cindex varargs implementation
4882
4883 GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4884 @code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4885 on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4886 varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4887 conditionals to include it.
4888
4889 ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4890 the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4891 implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4892 to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
4893 @code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4894 supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4895
4896 However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
4897 the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4898 below.
4899
4900 @defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
4901 Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
4902 that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
4903 versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
4904 you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
4905
4906 On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
4907 control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
4908 other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
4909 found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4910
4911 Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4912 beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4913 @code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4914 This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4915 to use them for its own purposes.
4916 @c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4917 @c 10feb93
4918 @end defmac
4919
4920 @defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
4921 This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
4922 argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
4923 returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
4924 argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
4925 fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
4926 verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
4927 of the current function.
4928 @end defmac
4929
4930 @defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
4931 Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
4932 passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
4933 has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
4934 specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
4935 with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
4936
4937 @code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
4938 considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
4939 kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
4940
4941 The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
4942 interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
4943 @end defmac
4944
4945 These machine description macros help implement varargs:
4946
4947 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS (void)
4948 If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
4949 @code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
4950 beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
4951 return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
4952 to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
4953 @end deftypefn
4954
4955 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
4956 This target hook offers an alternative to using
4957 @code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
4958 @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
4959 register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
4960 have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
4961 use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
4962 pass all their arguments on the stack.
4963
4964 The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
4965 structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
4966 named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
4967 last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
4968
4969 The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
4970 argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
4971 store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
4972 variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
4973 store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
4974 frame.
4975
4976 Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
4977 compile time without knowing their data types,
4978 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
4979 have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
4980 for all data types.
4981
4982 If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
4983 arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
4984 happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
4985 end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
4986 not generate any instructions in this case.
4987 @end deftypefn
4988
4989 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
4990 Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
4991 argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
4992
4993 This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
4994 is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
4995 @code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
4996 arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
4997 but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
4998 then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
4999 except the last are treated as named.
5000
5001 You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5002 @end deftypefn
5003
5004 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CALL_ARGS (rtx, @var{tree})
5005 While generating RTL for a function call, this target hook is invoked once
5006 for each argument passed to the function, either a register returned by
5007 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} or a memory location. It is called just
5008 before the point where argument registers are stored. The type of the
5009 function to be called is also passed as the second argument; it is
5010 @code{NULL_TREE} for libcalls. The @code{TARGET_END_CALL_ARGS} hook is
5011 invoked just after the code to copy the return reg has been emitted.
5012 This functionality can be used to perform special setup of call argument
5013 registers if a target needs it.
5014 For functions without arguments, the hook is called once with @code{pc_rtx}
5015 passed instead of an argument register.
5016 Most ports do not need to implement anything for this hook.
5017 @end deftypefn
5018
5019 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_END_CALL_ARGS (void)
5020 This target hook is invoked while generating RTL for a function call,
5021 just after the point where the return reg is copied into a pseudo. It
5022 signals that all the call argument and return registers for the just
5023 emitted call are now no longer in use.
5024 Most ports do not need to implement anything for this hook.
5025 @end deftypefn
5026
5027 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5028 If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5029 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5030 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5031 defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5032 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5033 Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5034 @end deftypefn
5035
5036 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LOAD_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG (rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{arg}, rtx @var{slot_no})
5037 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to load bounds of
5038 @var{arg} passed in @var{slot}. Expand pass uses this hook in case
5039 bounds of @var{arg} are not passed in register. If @var{slot} is a
5040 memory, then bounds are loaded as for regular pointer loaded from
5041 memory. If @var{slot} is not a memory then @var{slot_no} is an integer
5042 constant holding number of the target dependent special slot which
5043 should be used to obtain bounds. Hook returns RTX holding loaded bounds.
5044 @end deftypefn
5045
5046 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_STORE_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG (rtx @var{arg}, rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{bounds}, rtx @var{slot_no})
5047 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insns to store @var{bounds} of
5048 @var{arg} passed in @var{slot}. Expand pass uses this hook in case
5049 @var{bounds} of @var{arg} are not passed in register. If @var{slot} is a
5050 memory, then @var{bounds} are stored as for regular pointer stored in
5051 memory. If @var{slot} is not a memory then @var{slot_no} is an integer
5052 constant holding number of the target dependent special slot which
5053 should be used to store @var{bounds}.
5054 @end deftypefn
5055
5056 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LOAD_RETURNED_BOUNDS (rtx @var{slot})
5057 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to load bounds
5058 returned by function call in @var{slot}. Hook returns RTX holding
5059 loaded bounds.
5060 @end deftypefn
5061
5062 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_STORE_RETURNED_BOUNDS (rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{bounds})
5063 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to store @var{bounds}
5064 returned by function call into @var{slot}.
5065 @end deftypefn
5066
5067 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_CHKP_FUNCTION_VALUE_BOUNDS (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
5068 Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
5069 returns bounds for returned pointers. Arguments meaning is similar to
5070 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE}.
5071 @end deftypefn
5072
5073 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARG_BOUNDS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
5074 Use it to store bounds for anonymous register arguments stored
5075 into the stack. Arguments meaning is similar to
5076 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}.
5077 @end deftypefn
5078
5079 @node Trampolines
5080 @section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5081 @cindex trampolines for nested functions
5082 @cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5083
5084 A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5085 when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5086 the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
5087 tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5088 trampoline.
5089
5090 The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5091 address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5092 the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5093 two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5094 exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5095 machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5096 two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5097 operands.
5098
5099 The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5100 parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5101 immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5102 simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5103 proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5104 may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5105 separately.
5106
5107 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (FILE *@var{f})
5108 This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5109 on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5110 the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5111 label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5112
5113 If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5114 for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5115 code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5116 to generate it on the spot.
5117 @end deftypefn
5118
5119 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5120 Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5121 (@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5122 @end defmac
5123
5124 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5125 A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5126 @end defmac
5127
5128 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5129 Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5130
5131 If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5132 is used for aligning trampolines.
5133 @end defmac
5134
5135 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT (rtx @var{m_tramp}, tree @var{fndecl}, rtx @var{static_chain})
5136 This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5137 @var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5138 is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5139 RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5140 when it is called.
5141
5142 If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5143 first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5144 from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5145 Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5146 trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5147 to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5148
5149 If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5150 enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5151 initializing the trampoline proper.
5152 @end deftypefn
5153
5154 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (rtx @var{addr})
5155 This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5156 the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5157 memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5158 the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5159 address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5160 be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5161 If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5162 @end deftypefn
5163
5164 Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5165 separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5166 fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5167 jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5168
5169 Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5170 the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5171 make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5172 subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5173 latter makes initialization faster.
5174
5175 To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5176 the following macro.
5177
5178 @defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5179 If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5180 cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5181 typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5182 @var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5183 @end defmac
5184
5185 To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5186 you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5187 cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5188 beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5189 its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5190
5191 @defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5192 Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5193 work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5194 which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5195 @code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5196
5197 If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5198 C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5199 special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5200 statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5201 global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5202 special assembler code.
5203 @end defmac
5204
5205 @node Library Calls
5206 @section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5207 @cindex library subroutine names
5208 @cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5209
5210 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5211 Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5212
5213 @defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5214 This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5215 expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5216 provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5217 are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5218 @end defmac
5219
5220 @findex set_optab_libfunc
5221 @findex init_one_libfunc
5222 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS (void)
5223 This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5224 existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5225 @code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5226 @code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5227 library routines.
5228
5229 The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5230 @end deftypefn
5231
5232 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5233 If false (the default), internal library routines start with two
5234 underscores. If set to true, these routines start with @code{__gnu_}
5235 instead. E.g., @code{__muldi3} changes to @code{__gnu_muldi3}. This
5236 currently only affects functions defined in @file{libgcc2.c}. If this
5237 is set to true, the @file{tm.h} file must also
5238 @code{#define LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX}.
5239 @end deftypevr
5240
5241 @defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5242 This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5243 implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5244 mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5245 return a tristate.
5246
5247 GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5248 comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5249 don't need to define this macro.
5250 @end defmac
5251
5252 @defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5253 This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5254 functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5255 operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5256 and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5257 If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5258 @minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5259 in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5260 @end defmac
5261
5262 @defmac TARGET_HAS_NO_HW_DIVIDE
5263 This macro should be defined if the target has no hardware divide
5264 instructions. If this macro is defined, GCC will use an algorithm which
5265 make use of simple logical and arithmetic operations for 64-bit
5266 division. If the macro is not defined, GCC will use an algorithm which
5267 make use of a 64-bit by 32-bit divide primitive.
5268 @end defmac
5269
5270 @cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5271 @findex matherr
5272 @defmac TARGET_EDOM
5273 The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5274 expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5275 deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5276 @file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5277 system.
5278
5279 If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5280 domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5281 error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5282 there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5283 that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5284 @end defmac
5285
5286 @cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5287 @defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5288 Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5289 refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5290 @code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5291 macro, a reasonable default is used.
5292 @end defmac
5293
5294 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBC_HAS_FUNCTION (enum function_class @var{fn_class})
5295 This hook determines whether a function from a class of functions
5296 @var{fn_class} is present at the runtime.
5297 @end deftypefn
5298
5299 @defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5300 Set this macro to 1 to use the "NeXT" Objective-C message sending conventions
5301 by default. This calling convention involves passing the object, the selector
5302 and the method arguments all at once to the method-lookup library function.
5303 This is the usual setting when targeting Darwin/Mac OS X systems, which have
5304 the NeXT runtime installed.
5305
5306 If the macro is set to 0, the "GNU" Objective-C message sending convention
5307 will be used by default. This convention passes just the object and the
5308 selector to the method-lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5309
5310 In either case, it remains possible to select code-generation for the alternate
5311 scheme, by means of compiler command line switches.
5312 @end defmac
5313
5314 @node Addressing Modes
5315 @section Addressing Modes
5316 @cindex addressing modes
5317
5318 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5319 This is about addressing modes.
5320
5321 @defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5322 @defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5323 @defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5324 @defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5325 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5326 pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5327 @end defmac
5328
5329 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5330 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5331 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5332 post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5333 the size of the memory operand.
5334 @end defmac
5335
5336 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5337 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5338 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5339 post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5340 @end defmac
5341
5342 @defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5343 A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5344 is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5345 @code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5346 is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5347 constant addresses are supported.
5348 @end defmac
5349
5350 @defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5351 @code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5352 accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5353 known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5354 expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5355 @code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5356 @end defmac
5357
5358 @defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5359 A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5360 memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5361 the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5362 accept.
5363 @end defmac
5364
5365 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, bool @var{strict})
5366 A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5367 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5368
5369 Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5370 non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5371 desired by the caller.
5372
5373 The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5374 that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5375 considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5376 kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5377 must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5378 up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5379 register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5380 if the array holds @code{-1}.
5381
5382 The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5383 accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5384 register is required.
5385
5386 Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5387 and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5388 constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5389 specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5390 recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5391
5392 Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5393 sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5394 @code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5395 naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5396 be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5397
5398 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5399 On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5400 the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5401 target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5402 into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5403 @code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5404 @code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5405 Format}.
5406
5407 @cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5408 Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5409 this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5410 has this syntax:
5411
5412 @example
5413 #define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5414 @end example
5415
5416 @noindent
5417 and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5418 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5419
5420 @findex REG_OK_STRICT
5421 Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5422 macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5423 @code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5424 that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5425
5426 Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5427 files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5428 @end deftypefn
5429
5430 @defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5431 A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5432 character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5433 letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5434 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5435 support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5436 semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5437 preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5438 @code{'m'} constraint.
5439 @end defmac
5440
5441 @defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5442 A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5443 or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5444 can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5445 @code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5446
5447 It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5448 that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5449
5450 The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5451 a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5452 @end defmac
5453
5454 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, machine_mode @var{mode})
5455 This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5456 operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5457 address.
5458
5459 @findex break_out_memory_refs
5460 @var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5461 and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5462 @var{x}.
5463
5464 The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5465 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5466 should return the new @var{x}.
5467
5468 It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address,
5469 with the exception of native TLS addresses (@pxref{Emulated TLS}).
5470 The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, if
5471 the target supports only emulated TLS, it
5472 is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5473 a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5474 strategy can generate better code.
5475 @end deftypefn
5476
5477 @defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5478 A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5479 that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5480 @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5481 It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5482 performance reasons.
5483
5484 For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5485 reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5486 registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5487 processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5488 needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5489 @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5490 generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5491 be shared.
5492
5493 @emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5494 to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5495 and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5496 of reload internals.
5497
5498 @emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5499 previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5500 then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5501
5502 @findex push_reload
5503 The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5504 need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5505 suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5506
5507 The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5508 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5509 should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5510 This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5511 @code{push_reload}.
5512
5513 @findex strict_memory_address_p
5514 The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5515 the address has become legitimate.
5516
5517 @findex copy_rtx
5518 If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5519 this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5520 single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5521 top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5522 It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5523 address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5524 @end defmac
5525
5526 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P (const_rtx @var{addr}, addr_space_t @var{addrspace})
5527 This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} in address
5528 space @var{addrspace} can have
5529 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5530 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5531 but not others.
5532
5533 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5534 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5535 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5536 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5537
5538 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5539
5540 The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5541 @end deftypefn
5542
5543 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5544 This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5545 @var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5546 @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5547
5548 The default definition returns true.
5549 @end deftypefn
5550
5551 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x})
5552 This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5553 @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5554 macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5555 references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5556 addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5557 the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5558 into their original form.
5559 @end deftypefn
5560
5561 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CONST_NOT_OK_FOR_DEBUG_P (rtx @var{x})
5562 This hook should return true if @var{x} should not be emitted into
5563 debug sections.
5564 @end deftypefn
5565
5566 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5567 This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5568 should not) be spilled to the constant pool. @var{mode} is the mode
5569 of @var{x}.
5570
5571 The default version of this hook returns false.
5572
5573 The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5574 deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5575 from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5576 holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5577 of TLS symbols for various targets.
5578 @end deftypefn
5579
5580 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{x})
5581 This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5582 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5583 of @var{x}.
5584
5585 The default version returns false for all constants.
5586 @end deftypefn
5587
5588 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_DECL_P (const_tree @var{decl})
5589 This hook should return true if pool entries for @var{decl} should
5590 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure.
5591
5592 The default version returns true for all decls.
5593 @end deftypefn
5594
5595 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL (unsigned @var{fn}, bool @var{md_fn}, bool @var{sqrt})
5596 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
5597 the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5598 @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. @var{md_fn} is true
5599 when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function. When
5600 @var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5601 of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5602 function are valid.
5603 @end deftypefn
5604
5605 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD (void)
5606 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5607 address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5608 used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5609 @var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5610
5611 The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5612 @var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5613 the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5614 @code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5615 two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5616 @var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5617 the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5618 from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5619 @var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5620 @var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5621 @var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5622
5623 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5624 to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5625 use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5626 @code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5627 should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5628 described above.
5629 If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5630 the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5631 log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5632 @end deftypefn
5633
5634 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST (enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{type_of_cost}, tree @var{vectype}, int @var{misalign})
5635 Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
5636 For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5637 misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
5638 @end deftypefn
5639
5640 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE (const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{is_packed})
5641 Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5642 @end deftypefn
5643
5644 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VEC_PERM_CONST_OK (machine_mode, const unsigned char *@var{sel})
5645 Return true if a vector created for @code{vec_perm_const} is valid.
5646 @end deftypefn
5647
5648 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{dest_type}, tree @var{src_type})
5649 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5650 input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5651 The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5652 specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5653 (truncation, rounding, etc.).
5654
5655 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5656 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5657 conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5658 @end deftypefn
5659
5660 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5661 This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5662 vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5663 @var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5664 The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration. The
5665 return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5666 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5667 @end deftypefn
5668
5669 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, int @var{misalignment}, bool @var{is_packed})
5670 This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5671 store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5672 parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5673 the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5674 parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5675 @end deftypefn
5676
5677 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
5678 This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5679 mode @var{mode}. The default is
5680 equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
5681 transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5682 @end deftypefn
5683
5684 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES (void)
5685 This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5686 after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5687 mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5688 The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5689 @end deftypefn
5690
5691 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST (struct loop *@var{loop_info})
5692 This hook should initialize target-specific data structures in preparation for modeling the costs of vectorizing a loop or basic block. The default allocates three unsigned integers for accumulating costs for the prologue, body, and epilogue of the loop or basic block. If @var{loop_info} is non-NULL, it identifies the loop being vectorized; otherwise a single block is being vectorized.
5693 @end deftypefn
5694
5695 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_VECTORIZE_ADD_STMT_COST (void *@var{data}, int @var{count}, enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{kind}, struct _stmt_vec_info *@var{stmt_info}, int @var{misalign}, enum vect_cost_model_location @var{where})
5696 This hook should update the target-specific @var{data} in response to adding @var{count} copies of the given @var{kind} of statement to a loop or basic block. The default adds the builtin vectorizer cost for the copies of the statement to the accumulator specified by @var{where}, (the prologue, body, or epilogue) and returns the amount added. The return value should be viewed as a tentative cost that may later be revised.
5697 @end deftypefn
5698
5699 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_FINISH_COST (void *@var{data}, unsigned *@var{prologue_cost}, unsigned *@var{body_cost}, unsigned *@var{epilogue_cost})
5700 This hook should complete calculations of the cost of vectorizing a loop or basic block based on @var{data}, and return the prologue, body, and epilogue costs as unsigned integers. The default returns the value of the three accumulators.
5701 @end deftypefn
5702
5703 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_DESTROY_COST_DATA (void *@var{data})
5704 This hook should release @var{data} and any related data structures allocated by TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST. The default releases the accumulator.
5705 @end deftypefn
5706
5707 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_LOAD (tree)
5708 This hook should return the built-in decl needed to load a vector of the given type within a transaction.
5709 @end deftypefn
5710
5711 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_STORE (tree)
5712 This hook should return the built-in decl needed to store a vector of the given type within a transaction.
5713 @end deftypefn
5714
5715 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_GATHER (const_tree @var{mem_vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
5716 Target builtin that implements vector gather operation. @var{mem_vectype}
5717 is the vector type of the load and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
5718 the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
5719 The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize gather
5720 loads.
5721 @end deftypefn
5722
5723 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_COMPUTE_VECSIZE_AND_SIMDLEN (struct cgraph_node *@var{}, struct cgraph_simd_clone *@var{}, @var{tree}, @var{int})
5724 This hook should set @var{vecsize_mangle}, @var{vecsize_int}, @var{vecsize_float}
5725 fields in @var{simd_clone} structure pointed by @var{clone_info} argument and also
5726 @var{simdlen} field if it was previously 0.
5727 The hook should return 0 if SIMD clones shouldn't be emitted,
5728 or number of @var{vecsize_mangle} variants that should be emitted.
5729 @end deftypefn
5730
5731 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_ADJUST (struct cgraph_node *@var{})
5732 This hook should add implicit @code{attribute(target("..."))} attribute
5733 to SIMD clone @var{node} if needed.
5734 @end deftypefn
5735
5736 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_USABLE (struct cgraph_node *@var{})
5737 This hook should return -1 if SIMD clone @var{node} shouldn't be used
5738 in vectorized loops in current function, or non-negative number if it is
5739 usable. In that case, the smaller the number is, the more desirable it is
5740 to use it.
5741 @end deftypefn
5742
5743 @node Anchored Addresses
5744 @section Anchored Addresses
5745 @cindex anchored addresses
5746 @cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5747
5748 GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5749 For example, if we have:
5750
5751 @smallexample
5752 static int a, b, c;
5753 int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5754 @end smallexample
5755
5756 the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5757 addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5758 it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5759 the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5760 be something like:
5761
5762 @smallexample
5763 int foo (void)
5764 @{
5765 register int *xr = &x;
5766 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5767 @}
5768 @end smallexample
5769
5770 (which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5771 ``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5772
5773 The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5774 in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5775 section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5776 or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5777
5778 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5779 The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5780 On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5781 applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5782 for every mode. The default value is 0.
5783 @end deftypevr
5784
5785 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5786 Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5787 offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5788 value is 0.
5789 @end deftypevr
5790
5791 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR (rtx @var{x})
5792 Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5793 @code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5794 The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5795 of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5796
5797 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5798 it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5799 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5800 is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5801 @end deftypefn
5802
5803 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P (const_rtx @var{x})
5804 Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5805 @var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5806 @samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5807
5808 The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5809 intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5810 or target-specific sections.
5811 @end deftypefn
5812
5813 @node Condition Code
5814 @section Condition Code Status
5815 @cindex condition code status
5816
5817 The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5818 two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5819
5820 The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5821 (@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5822 clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5823 register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5824 architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5825 most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5826 most RISC machines.
5827
5828 The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5829 the definition and use of the condition code. In the past the definition
5830 and use were always adjacent. However, recent changes to support trapping
5831 arithmatic may result in the definition and user being in different blocks.
5832 Thus, there may be a @code{NOTE_INSN_BASIC_BLOCK} between them. Additionally,
5833 the definition may be the source of exception handling edges.
5834
5835 These restrictions can prevent important
5836 optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5837 is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5838 three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5839 scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5840 separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5841
5842 For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5843 represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5844 condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5845 condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5846 or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5847 Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5848 that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5849
5850 Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5851 specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5852 interested in most macros in this section.
5853
5854 @menu
5855 * CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5856 * MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
5857 @end menu
5858
5859 @node CC0 Condition Codes
5860 @subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5861 @findex cc0
5862
5863 @findex cc_status
5864 The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5865 describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5866 the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5867 variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5868 currently based, and several standard flags.
5869
5870 Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5871 description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5872 information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5873
5874 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
5875 C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5876 component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5877
5878 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5879 @end defmac
5880
5881 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5882 A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5883 The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5884 the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5885 define this macro to initialize it.
5886
5887 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5888 @end defmac
5889
5890 @defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5891 A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5892 appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5893 this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5894 code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5895 set @code{(cc0)}.
5896
5897 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5898
5899 If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5900 other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5901 invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5902 reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5903 registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5904 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5905 insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5906 based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5907 value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5908 this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5909 @samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5910 @code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5911 condition code value.
5912
5913 The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5914 with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5915 @code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5916 constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5917 insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5918 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5919 @code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5920
5921 A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5922 that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5923 @samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5924 two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5925 @end defmac
5926
5927 @node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5928 @subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5929 @findex CCmode
5930 @findex MODE_CC
5931
5932 @defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5933 On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5934 than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
5935 code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
5936 when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
5937 bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
5938 branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
5939 this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
5940 record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
5941 also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
5942 unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
5943
5944 If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
5945 @file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
5946 a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
5947 have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
5948 by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
5949 be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
5950 the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
5951
5952 @smallexample
5953 (define_insn ""
5954 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
5955 (compare:CC_NOOV
5956 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
5957 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
5958 (const_int 0)))]
5959 ""
5960 "@dots{}")
5961 @end smallexample
5962
5963 @noindent
5964 together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
5965 for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
5966
5967 @smallexample
5968 #define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
5969 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
5970 ? ((OP == LT || OP == LE || OP == GT || OP == GE) \
5971 ? CCFPEmode : CCFPmode) \
5972 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
5973 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG || GET_CODE (x) == ASHIFT) \
5974 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
5975 @end smallexample
5976
5977 Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
5978 were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
5979 this section.
5980
5981 You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
5982 in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
5983 @end defmac
5984
5985 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (int *@var{code}, rtx *@var{op0}, rtx *@var{op1}, bool @var{op0_preserve_value})
5986 On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
5987 convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
5988 does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
5989 comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
5990
5991 On such machines, implement this hook to do any required conversions.
5992 @var{code} is the initial comparison code and @var{op0} and @var{op1}
5993 are the left and right operands of the comparison, respectively. If
5994 @var{op0_preserve_value} is @code{true} the implementation is not
5995 allowed to change the value of @var{op0} since the value might be used
5996 in RTXs which aren't comparisons. E.g. the implementation is not
5997 allowed to swap operands in that case.
5998
5999 GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
6000 valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
6001 @file{md} file.
6002
6003 You need not to implement this hook if it would never change the
6004 comparison code or operands.
6005 @end deftypefn
6006
6007 @defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
6008 A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
6009 comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
6010 can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
6011 then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
6012
6013 You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
6014 floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
6015 For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
6016 inequality comparisons are given either @code{CCFPEmode} or @code{CCFPmode}:
6017
6018 @smallexample
6019 #define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) \
6020 ((MODE) != CCFPEmode && (MODE) != CCFPmode)
6021 @end smallexample
6022 @end defmac
6023
6024 @defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
6025 A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6026 comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
6027 @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
6028 machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
6029 instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6030 freely convert unordered compares to ordered ones. Then definition may look
6031 like:
6032
6033 @smallexample
6034 #define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
6035 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
6036 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6037 @end smallexample
6038 @end defmac
6039
6040 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS (unsigned int *@var{p1}, unsigned int *@var{p2})
6041 On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6042 register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6043 regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6044 hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6045 small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6046 to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6047 arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6048 When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6049 integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6050 @code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6051
6052 The default version of this hook returns false.
6053 @end deftypefn
6054
6055 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE (machine_mode @var{m1}, machine_mode @var{m2})
6056 On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6057 @code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6058 validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6059 target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6060 both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6061 return @code{VOIDmode}.
6062
6063 The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6064 same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6065 returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6066 @end deftypefn
6067
6068 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
6069 If the target has a dedicated flags register, and it needs to use the post-reload comparison elimination pass, then this value should be set appropriately.
6070 @end deftypevr
6071
6072 @node Costs
6073 @section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6074 @cindex costs of instructions
6075 @cindex relative costs
6076 @cindex speed of instructions
6077
6078 These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6079 on the target machine.
6080
6081 @defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6082 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6083 register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6084 expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6085 value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6086 that.
6087
6088 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6089 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6090 registers if they are not general registers.
6091
6092 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6093 hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6094 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6095 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6096 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6097 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6098
6099 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6100 @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6101 @end defmac
6102
6103 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{from}, reg_class_t @var{to})
6104 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6105 from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6106 are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6107 A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6108 that.
6109
6110 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6111 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6112 registers if they are not general registers.
6113
6114 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6115 hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6116 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6117 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6118 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6119 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6120
6121 The default version of this function returns 2.
6122 @end deftypefn
6123
6124 @defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6125 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6126 register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6127 is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6128 is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6129 registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6130 should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6131
6132 If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6133 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6134 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6135 between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6136 more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6137 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6138
6139 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6140 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6141 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6142 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6143 4 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6144 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6145 are the same as to this macro.
6146
6147 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6148 @code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6149 @end defmac
6150
6151 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{rclass}, bool @var{in})
6152 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6153 between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
6154 if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6155 This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6156 If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6157 registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6158
6159 If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6160 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6161 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6162 between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
6163 more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6164 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6165
6166 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6167 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6168 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6169 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6170 4 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6171 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6172 are the same as to this target hook.
6173 @end deftypefn
6174
6175 @defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6176 A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
6177 the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6178 @var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6179 for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6180 optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is
6181 true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6182 @code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
6183 @end defmac
6184
6185 Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6186 but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6187 ordinarily expect.
6188
6189 @defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6190 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6191 than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6192 faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6193 require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6194 between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6195
6196 When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6197 finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6198 load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6199 faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6200 may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6201 other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6202 @end defmac
6203
6204 @defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6205 Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6206 @var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6207 than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6208 handler.
6209
6210 When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6211 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6212 moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6213 Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6214 cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6215
6216 If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
6217 this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6218 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6219 @end defmac
6220
6221 @defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6222 The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6223 which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6224 string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6225 make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6226
6227 Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6228 @code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6229 the number of such sequences.
6230
6231 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6232 optimized for speed rather than size.
6233
6234 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6235 @end defmac
6236
6237 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BY_PIECES_INFRASTRUCTURE_P (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size}, unsigned int @var{alignment}, enum by_pieces_operation @var{op}, bool @var{speed_p})
6238 GCC will attempt several strategies when asked to copy between
6239 two areas of memory, or to set, clear or store to memory, for example
6240 when copying a @code{struct}. The @code{by_pieces} infrastructure
6241 implements such memory operations as a sequence of load, store or move
6242 insns. Alternate strategies are to expand the
6243 @code{movmem} or @code{setmem} optabs, to emit a library call, or to emit
6244 unit-by-unit, loop-based operations.
6245
6246 This target hook should return true if, for a memory operation with a
6247 given @var{size} and @var{alignment}, using the @code{by_pieces}
6248 infrastructure is expected to result in better code generation.
6249 Both @var{size} and @var{alignment} are measured in terms of storage
6250 units.
6251
6252 The parameter @var{op} is one of: @code{CLEAR_BY_PIECES},
6253 @code{MOVE_BY_PIECES}, @code{SET_BY_PIECES}, @code{STORE_BY_PIECES}.
6254 These describe the type of memory operation under consideration.
6255
6256 The parameter @var{speed_p} is true if the code is currently being
6257 optimized for speed rather than size.
6258
6259 Returning true for higher values of @var{size} can improve code generation
6260 for speed if the target does not provide an implementation of the
6261 @code{movmem} or @code{setmem} standard names, if the @code{movmem} or
6262 @code{setmem} implementation would be more expensive than a sequence of
6263 insns, or if the overhead of a library call would dominate that of
6264 the body of the memory operation.
6265
6266 Returning true for higher values of @code{size} may also cause an increase
6267 in code size, for example where the number of insns emitted to perform a
6268 move would be greater than that of a library call.
6269 @end deftypefn
6270
6271 @defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6272 A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6273 a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6274 @end defmac
6275
6276 @defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6277 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6278 of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6279 or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6280 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6281
6282 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6283 optimized for speed rather than size.
6284
6285 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6286 @end defmac
6287
6288 @defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6289 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6290 of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6291 a block set insn or a library call.
6292 Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6293 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6294
6295 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6296 optimized for speed rather than size.
6297
6298 If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6299 @end defmac
6300
6301 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6302 A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6303 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6304 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6305 @end defmac
6306
6307 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6308 A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6309 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6310 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6311 @end defmac
6312
6313 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6314 A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6315 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6316 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6317 @end defmac
6318
6319 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6320 A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6321 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6322 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6323 @end defmac
6324
6325 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6326 A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6327 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6328 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6329 @end defmac
6330
6331 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6332 A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6333 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6334 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6335 @end defmac
6336
6337 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6338 This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6339 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6340 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6341 @end defmac
6342
6343 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6344 This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6345 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6346 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6347 @end defmac
6348
6349 @defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6350 Define this macro to be true if it is as good or better to call a constant
6351 function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6352 @end defmac
6353
6354 @defmac LOGICAL_OP_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6355 Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6356 @samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6357 @code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6358 @end defmac
6359
6360 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RTX_COSTS (rtx @var{x}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{outer_code}, int @var{opno}, int *@var{total}, bool @var{speed})
6361 This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6362
6363 The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6364 available for examination in @var{x}, and the fact that @var{x} appears
6365 as operand @var{opno} of an expression with rtx code @var{outer_code}.
6366 That is, the hook can assume that there is some rtx @var{y} such
6367 that @samp{GET_CODE (@var{y}) == @var{outer_code}} and such that
6368 either (a) @samp{XEXP (@var{y}, @var{opno}) == @var{x}} or
6369 (b) @samp{XVEC (@var{y}, @var{opno})} contains @var{x}.
6370
6371 @var{mode} is @var{x}'s machine mode, or for cases like @code{const_int} that
6372 do not have a mode, the mode in which @var{x} is used.
6373
6374 In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6375 @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6376 instructions.
6377
6378 On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6379 for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6380 necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6381 for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6382 operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6383
6384 When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6385 false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6386 size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6387
6388 The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6389 processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6390 @end deftypefn
6391
6392 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDRESS_COST (rtx @var{address}, machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as}, bool @var{speed})
6393 This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6394 @var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6395 the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6396
6397 For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6398 true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6399 instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6400 all addresses will have equal costs.
6401
6402 In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6403 the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6404 cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6405
6406 For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6407 and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6408 is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6409 references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6410 the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6411 that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6412 instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6413 specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6414
6415 This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6416
6417 On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6418 cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6419 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6420 be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6421 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6422 should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6423 should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6424 registers on machines with lots of registers.
6425 @end deftypefn
6426
6427 @node Scheduling
6428 @section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6429
6430 The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6431 adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6432 hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6433 them: try the first ones in this list first.
6434
6435 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
6436 This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6437 issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6438 Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6439 an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6440 constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6441 hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6442 This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6443 it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6444 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6445 @end deftypefn
6446
6447 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{more})
6448 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6449 from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6450 still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6451 @samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6452 @code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6453 You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6454 than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6455 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6456 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6457 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6458 was scheduled.
6459 @end deftypefn
6460
6461 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx @var{link}, rtx_insn *@var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost})
6462 This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6463 relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6464 dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6465 is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6466 to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
6467 that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
6468 data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6469 description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6470 output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6471 times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6472 acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6473 @pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6474 @end deftypefn
6475
6476 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{priority})
6477 This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6478 @var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6479 execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6480 later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6481 scheduling priorities of insns.
6482 @end deftypefn
6483
6484 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn **@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6485 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6486 list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6487 combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6488 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6489 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6490 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6491 list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6492 a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6493 reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6494 @var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
6495 is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6496 the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6497 can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6498 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6499 @end deftypefn
6500
6501 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn **@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6502 Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6503 function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6504 is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6505 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6506 return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6507 this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6508 scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6509 cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6510 @end deftypefn
6511
6512 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_MACRO_FUSION_P (void)
6513 This hook is used to check whether target platform supports macro fusion.
6514 @end deftypefn
6515
6516 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_MACRO_FUSION_PAIR_P (rtx_insn *@var{prev}, rtx_insn *@var{curr})
6517 This hook is used to check whether two insns should be macro fused for
6518 a target microarchitecture. If this hook returns true for the given insn pair
6519 (@var{prev} and @var{curr}), the scheduler will put them into a sched
6520 group, and they will not be scheduled apart. The two insns will be either
6521 two SET insns or a compare and a conditional jump and this hook should
6522 validate any dependencies needed to fuse the two insns together.
6523 @end deftypefn
6524
6525 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx_insn *@var{head}, rtx_insn *@var{tail})
6526 This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6527 chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6528 correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6529 example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6530 analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6531 dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6532 calculated.
6533 @end deftypefn
6534
6535 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
6536 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6537 instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6538 pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6539 is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6540 @var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6541 region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
6542 scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6543 @end deftypefn
6544
6545 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6546 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6547 instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6548 cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6549 is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6550 to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6551 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6552 @end deftypefn
6553
6554 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{old_max_uid})
6555 This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6556 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6557 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6558 @var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6559 @end deftypefn
6560
6561 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6562 This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6563 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6564 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6565 @end deftypefn
6566
6567 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6568 The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6569 pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6570 when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6571 simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6572 processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6573 based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6574 when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6575 @end deftypefn
6576
6577 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6578 The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6579 @end deftypefn
6580
6581 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6582 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6583 to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6584 simulated processor cycle finishes.
6585 @end deftypefn
6586
6587 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6588 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6589 used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6590 @end deftypefn
6591
6592 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6593 The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6594 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6595 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6596 state on a single insn is not enough.
6597 @end deftypefn
6598
6599 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6600 The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6601 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6602 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6603 state on a single insn is not enough.
6604 @end deftypefn
6605
6606 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void)
6607 This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6608 for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6609 chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6610 value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6611 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6612 subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6613 maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6614 @acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6615 packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6616 rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6617
6618 This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6619 processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6620 with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6621 @var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6622 @var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6623 processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6624 @var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6625 until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6626 the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6627
6628 Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6629 pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6630 schedules to choose the best one.
6631
6632 The default is no multipass scheduling.
6633 @end deftypefn
6634
6635 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{ready_index})
6636
6637 This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6638 considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
6639 zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be considered in multipass scheduling.
6640 Positive return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration on
6641 the current round of multipass scheduling.
6642 Negative return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration for given
6643 number of cycles.
6644 Backends should be careful about returning non-zero for highest priority
6645 instruction at position 0 in the ready list. @var{ready_index} is passed
6646 to allow backends make correct judgements.
6647
6648 The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6649 @end deftypefn
6650
6651 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN (void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, bool @var{first_cycle_insn_p})
6652 This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6653 scheduling.
6654 @end deftypefn
6655
6656 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE (void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, const void *@var{prev_data})
6657 This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6658 @end deftypefn
6659
6660 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK (const void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready})
6661 This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6662 an instruction.
6663 @end deftypefn
6664
6665 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END (const void *@var{data})
6666 This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6667 round of multipass scheduling.
6668 @end deftypefn
6669
6670 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT (void *@var{data})
6671 This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6672 @end deftypefn
6673
6674 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI (void *@var{data})
6675 This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6676 @end deftypefn
6677
6678 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *@var{dump}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{last_clock}, int @var{clock}, int *@var{sort_p})
6679 This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6680 on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6681 @var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6682 the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6683 is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6684 start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6685 verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6686 @var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6687 processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6688 and the current processor cycle.
6689 @end deftypefn
6690
6691 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE (struct _dep *@var{_dep}, int @var{cost}, int @var{distance})
6692 This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6693 the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6694 are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
6695 to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6696 being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6697 dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6698 parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6699 The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6700 insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6701 and @code{false} otherwise.
6702
6703 Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6704 where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6705 delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6706 that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6707 important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6708 closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
6709 not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6710 @end deftypefn
6711
6712 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED (void)
6713 This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6714 the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6715 per instruction data structures.
6716 @end deftypefn
6717
6718 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT (void)
6719 Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6720 @end deftypefn
6721
6722 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc}, bool @var{clean_p})
6723 Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6724 It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6725 beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6726 @end deftypefn
6727
6728 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6729 Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6730 @end deftypefn
6731
6732 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6733 Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6734 @end deftypefn
6735
6736 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6737 Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6738 @end deftypefn
6739
6740 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, unsigned int @var{dep_status}, rtx *@var{new_pat})
6741 This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6742 speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6743 The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6744 version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6745 pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6746 or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6747 speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6748 the generated speculative pattern.
6749 @end deftypefn
6750
6751 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P (unsigned int @var{dep_status})
6752 This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6753 for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6754 instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6755 @end deftypefn
6756
6757 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx_insn *@var{label}, unsigned int @var{ds})
6758 This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6759 check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6760 speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6761 @var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6762 be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6763 recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6764 a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6765 @var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6766 @end deftypefn
6767
6768 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS (struct spec_info_def *@var{spec_info})
6769 This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6770 enabled/used.
6771 The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6772 The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6773 @end deftypefn
6774
6775 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII (struct ddg *@var{g})
6776 This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6777 resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6778 the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6779 backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6780 bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6781 of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6782 @end deftypefn
6783
6784 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{x})
6785 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6786 is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6787 @end deftypefn
6788
6789 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{x})
6790 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6791 in its second parameter.
6792 @end deftypefn
6793
6794 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
6795 True if the processor has an exposed pipeline, which means that not just
6796 the order of instructions is important for correctness when scheduling, but
6797 also the latencies of operations.
6798 @end deftypevr
6799
6800 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REASSOCIATION_WIDTH (unsigned int @var{opc}, machine_mode @var{mode})
6801 This hook is called by tree reassociator to determine a level of
6802 parallelism required in output calculations chain.
6803 @end deftypefn
6804
6805 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FUSION_PRIORITY (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{max_pri}, int *@var{fusion_pri}, int *@var{pri})
6806 This hook is called by scheduling fusion pass. It calculates fusion
6807 priorities for each instruction passed in by parameter. The priorities
6808 are returned via pointer parameters.
6809
6810 @var{insn} is the instruction whose priorities need to be calculated.
6811 @var{max_pri} is the maximum priority can be returned in any cases.
6812 @var{fusion_pri} is the pointer parameter through which @var{insn}'s
6813 fusion priority should be calculated and returned.
6814 @var{pri} is the pointer parameter through which @var{insn}'s priority
6815 should be calculated and returned.
6816
6817 Same @var{fusion_pri} should be returned for instructions which should
6818 be scheduled together. Different @var{pri} should be returned for
6819 instructions with same @var{fusion_pri}. @var{fusion_pri} is the major
6820 sort key, @var{pri} is the minor sort key. All instructions will be
6821 scheduled according to the two priorities. All priorities calculated
6822 should be between 0 (exclusive) and @var{max_pri} (inclusive). To avoid
6823 false dependencies, @var{fusion_pri} of instructions which need to be
6824 scheduled together should be smaller than @var{fusion_pri} of irrelevant
6825 instructions.
6826
6827 Given below example:
6828
6829 @smallexample
6830 ldr r10, [r1, 4]
6831 add r4, r4, r10
6832 ldr r15, [r2, 8]
6833 sub r5, r5, r15
6834 ldr r11, [r1, 0]
6835 add r4, r4, r11
6836 ldr r16, [r2, 12]
6837 sub r5, r5, r16
6838 @end smallexample
6839
6840 On targets like ARM/AArch64, the two pairs of consecutive loads should be
6841 merged. Since peephole2 pass can't help in this case unless consecutive
6842 loads are actually next to each other in instruction flow. That's where
6843 this scheduling fusion pass works. This hook calculates priority for each
6844 instruction based on its fustion type, like:
6845
6846 @smallexample
6847 ldr r10, [r1, 4] ; fusion_pri=99, pri=96
6848 add r4, r4, r10 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
6849 ldr r15, [r2, 8] ; fusion_pri=98, pri=92
6850 sub r5, r5, r15 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
6851 ldr r11, [r1, 0] ; fusion_pri=99, pri=100
6852 add r4, r4, r11 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
6853 ldr r16, [r2, 12] ; fusion_pri=98, pri=88
6854 sub r5, r5, r16 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
6855 @end smallexample
6856
6857 Scheduling fusion pass then sorts all ready to issue instructions according
6858 to the priorities. As a result, instructions of same fusion type will be
6859 pushed together in instruction flow, like:
6860
6861 @smallexample
6862 ldr r11, [r1, 0]
6863 ldr r10, [r1, 4]
6864 ldr r15, [r2, 8]
6865 ldr r16, [r2, 12]
6866 add r4, r4, r10
6867 sub r5, r5, r15
6868 add r4, r4, r11
6869 sub r5, r5, r16
6870 @end smallexample
6871
6872 Now peephole2 pass can simply merge the two pairs of loads.
6873
6874 Since scheduling fusion pass relies on peephole2 to do real fusion
6875 work, it is only enabled by default when peephole2 is in effect.
6876
6877 This is firstly introduced on ARM/AArch64 targets, please refer to
6878 the hook implementation for how different fusion types are supported.
6879 @end deftypefn
6880
6881 @node Sections
6882 @section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6883 @c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6884 @c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6885
6886 An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6887 data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6888 section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6889 section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6890 section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6891 of sections.
6892
6893 @file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6894 @code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6895 The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6896 is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6897 as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6898 initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6899 They may however depend on command-line flags.
6900
6901 @emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6902 use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6903 to be string literals.
6904
6905 Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6906 section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6907 should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6908 @code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6909
6910 You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6911 @code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6912 in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6913 @code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6914 create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6915 reuse @code{text_section}.
6916
6917 All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6918 if the target does not provide them.
6919
6920 @defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6921 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6922 assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6923 Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
6924 @end defmac
6925
6926 @defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6927 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6928 frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
6929 a default definition if the target supports named sections.
6930 @end defmac
6931
6932 @defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6933 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6934 executed functions in the program.
6935 @end defmac
6936
6937 @defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6938 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6939 assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6940 data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
6941 @end defmac
6942
6943 @defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6944 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6945 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6946 initialized, writable small data.
6947 @end defmac
6948
6949 @defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6950 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6951 assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6952 data.
6953 @end defmac
6954
6955 @defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6956 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6957 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6958 uninitialized global data. If not defined, and
6959 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
6960 uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
6961 @option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
6962 used.
6963 @end defmac
6964
6965 @defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6966 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6967 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6968 uninitialized, writable small data.
6969 @end defmac
6970
6971 @defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6972 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6973 assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6974 common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6975 @end defmac
6976
6977 @defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6978 If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6979 containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
6980 default is @code{'T'}.
6981 @end defmac
6982
6983 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6984 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6985 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6986 initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6987 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6988 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6989 @end defmac
6990
6991 @defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
6992 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6993 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6994 finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6995 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6996 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6997 @end defmac
6998
6999 @defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
7000 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7001 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7002 part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
7003 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
7004 both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7005 @end defmac
7006
7007 @defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
7008 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7009 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7010 part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
7011 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
7012 both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7013 @end defmac
7014
7015 @defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
7016 If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
7017 via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
7018 the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
7019 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
7020 to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
7021 sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
7022 ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
7023 registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
7024 constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
7025 @end defmac
7026
7027 @defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
7028 If defined, a string which names the section into which small
7029 variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
7030 when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
7031 you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
7032 they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
7033 expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
7034 MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
7035 require small data support from your application, but use this macro
7036 to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
7037 access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
7038 @end defmac
7039
7040 @defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
7041 If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
7042 arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
7043 @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
7044 and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
7045 @end defmac
7046
7047 @defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
7048 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
7049 tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
7050 section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
7051 readonly data section is used.
7052
7053 This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
7054 @end defmac
7055
7056 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS (void)
7057 Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
7058 @file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
7059 of its own that you need to create.
7060
7061 GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
7062 any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
7063 described below.
7064 @end deftypefn
7065
7066 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK (void)
7067 Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
7068 selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
7069 should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
7070 local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
7071
7072 The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
7073 is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
7074 when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
7075 in read-only sections even in executables.
7076 @end deftypefn
7077
7078 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7079 Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
7080 assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
7081 some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
7082 requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
7083 local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
7084 @var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
7085
7086 The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
7087 variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7088
7089 See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
7090 @end deftypefn
7091
7092 @defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
7093 Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
7094 for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
7095
7096 In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
7097 function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
7098 it is unlikely to be called.
7099 @end defmac
7100
7101 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc})
7102 Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
7103 and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7104 As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
7105 the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
7106
7107 The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
7108 ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
7109 example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
7110 Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7111 @end deftypefn
7112
7113 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION (tree @var{decl})
7114 Return the readonly data section associated with
7115 @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7116 The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7117 the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7118 if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7119 otherwise.
7120 @end deftypefn
7121
7122 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_MERGEABLE_RODATA_PREFIX
7123 Usually, the compiler uses the prefix @code{".rodata"} to construct
7124 section names for mergeable constant data. Define this macro to override
7125 the string if a different section name should be used.
7126 @end deftypevr
7127
7128 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_TM_CLONE_TABLE_SECTION (void)
7129 Return the section that should be used for transactional memory clone tables.
7130 @end deftypefn
7131
7132 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7133 Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7134 should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7135 constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7136 case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7137 in bits.
7138
7139 The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7140 constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7141 else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7142 @end deftypefn
7143
7144 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{id})
7145 Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7146 by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7147 the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7148 or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7149 hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7150 your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7151 returns the @var{id} provided.
7152 @end deftypefn
7153
7154 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, rtx @var{rtl}, int @var{new_decl_p})
7155 Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7156 treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7157 function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7158
7159 The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7160 @var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7161 an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7162 rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7163 in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7164
7165 In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7166 a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7167 will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7168 register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7169 rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7170 leave it alone.)
7171
7172 The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7173 that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7174 be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7175 declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7176 declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7177 @var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7178
7179 @cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7180 The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7181 @code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7182 Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7183 encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7184 discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7185
7186 The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7187 in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7188 @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7189 before overriding it.
7190 @end deftypefn
7191
7192 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *@var{name})
7193 Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7194 the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7195 may have added.
7196 @end deftypefn
7197
7198 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7199 Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7200 The default version of this hook always returns false.
7201 @end deftypefn
7202
7203 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7204 Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7205 ``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7206 @end deftypevr
7207
7208 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE (void)
7209 It returns true if target wants profile code emitted before prologue.
7210
7211 The default version of this hook use the target macro
7212 @code{PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE}.
7213 @end deftypefn
7214
7215 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7216 Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7217 rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7218 or executable image).
7219
7220 The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7221 for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7222 currently supported object file formats.
7223 @end deftypefn
7224
7225 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7226 Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7227 The default value is false.
7228 @end deftypevr
7229
7230
7231 @node PIC
7232 @section Position Independent Code
7233 @cindex position independent code
7234 @cindex PIC
7235
7236 This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7237 independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7238 generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7239 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7240 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7241 must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7242 when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7243 need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7244 relative addresses.
7245 @c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7246 @c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7247
7248 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7249 The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7250 data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7251 processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7252 is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7253 pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7254 is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7255 necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7256 when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7257 @end defmac
7258
7259 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
7260 A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7261 @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7262 the default is zero. Do not define
7263 this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7264 @end defmac
7265
7266 @defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7267 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7268 operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7269 You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7270 check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7271 check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7272 (including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7273 position independent code.
7274 @end defmac
7275
7276 @node Assembler Format
7277 @section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7278
7279 This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7280 to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7281 instructions do.
7282
7283 @menu
7284 * File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7285 * Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7286 * Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7287 * Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7288 * Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7289 and termination routines.
7290 * Macros for Initialization::
7291 Specific macros that control the handling of
7292 initialization and termination routines.
7293 * Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7294 * Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7295 * Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7296 * Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7297 @end menu
7298
7299 @node File Framework
7300 @subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7301 @cindex assembler format
7302 @cindex output of assembler code
7303
7304 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7305 This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7306
7307 @findex default_file_start
7308 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_START (void)
7309 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7310 find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7311 by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7312 quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7313 @code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7314 lets other target files rely on these variables.
7315 @end deftypefn
7316
7317 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7318 If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7319 printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7320 @option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7321 to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7322 definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7323 assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7324 whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7325
7326 The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7327 verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7328 comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7329 @end deftypevr
7330
7331 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7332 If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7333 for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7334 @code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7335 this to be done. The default is false.
7336 @end deftypevr
7337
7338 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_END (void)
7339 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7340 to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7341 @end deftypefn
7342
7343 @deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7344 Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7345 special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7346 the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7347 should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7348 need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7349 this function.
7350 @end deftypefun
7351
7352 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_START (void)
7353 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7354 to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7355 nothing.
7356 @end deftypefn
7357
7358 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_END (void)
7359 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7360 to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7361 nothing.
7362 @end deftypefn
7363
7364 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CODE_END (void)
7365 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7366 unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7367 here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7368 because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7369 nothing.
7370 @end deftypefn
7371
7372 @defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7373 A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7374 assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7375 the end of the line.
7376 @end defmac
7377
7378 @defmac ASM_APP_ON
7379 A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7380 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7381 @code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7382 assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7383 that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7384 @end defmac
7385
7386 @defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7387 A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7388 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7389 @code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7390 time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7391 @end defmac
7392
7393 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7394 A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7395 which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7396 the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7397
7398 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7399 for the file format in use is appropriate.
7400 @end defmac
7401
7402 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name})
7403 Output COFF information or DWARF debugging information which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to the stdio stream @var{file}.
7404
7405 This target hook need not be defined if the standard form of output for the file format in use is appropriate.
7406 @end deftypefn
7407
7408 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (const char *@var{name})
7409 Output a string based on @var{name}, suitable for the @samp{#ident} directive, or the equivalent directive or pragma in non-C-family languages. If this hook is not defined, nothing is output for the @samp{#ident} directive.
7410 @end deftypefn
7411
7412 @defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7413 A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7414 @var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7415 in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7416 the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7417 of the filename using this macro.
7418 @end defmac
7419
7420 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, tree @var{decl})
7421 Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7422 should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7423 of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7424 is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7425 this section is associated.
7426 @end deftypefn
7427
7428 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, enum node_frequency @var{freq}, bool @var{startup}, bool @var{exit})
7429 Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7430 Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
7431 functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
7432 at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7433 @var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7434 (from static destructors).
7435 Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7436 @end deftypefn
7437
7438 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{decl}, bool @var{new_is_cold})
7439 Used by the target to emit any assembler directives or additional labels needed when a function is partitioned between different sections. Output should be written to @var{file}. The function decl is available as @var{decl} and the new section is `cold' if @var{new_is_cold} is @code{true}.
7440 @end deftypefn
7441
7442 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7443 This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
7444 It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
7445 @end deftypevr
7446
7447 @anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7448 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7449 This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7450 section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7451 This is true on most ELF targets.
7452 @end deftypevr
7453
7454 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
7455 Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7456 based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7457 declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
7458 null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7459
7460 The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7461 read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7462 need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7463 set via @code{__attribute__}.
7464 @end deftypefn
7465
7466 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES (print_switch_type @var{type}, const char *@var{text})
7467 Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7468 switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7469 enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7470 It can take the following values:
7471
7472 @table @gcctabopt
7473 @item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7474 @var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7475
7476 @item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7477 @var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7478 direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7479 default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7480 command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7481 various different individual optimization passes.
7482
7483 @item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7484 @var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7485 ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7486 target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7487 time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7488 warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7489 wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7490 necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7491 perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7492 switches.
7493
7494 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7495 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7496
7497 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7498 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7499 @end table
7500
7501 The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7502 supported in the future.
7503
7504 By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7505 provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7506 it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7507 section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7508 provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7509 hook.
7510 @end deftypefn
7511
7512 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7513 This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7514 ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7515 hook.
7516 @end deftypevr
7517
7518 @need 2000
7519 @node Data Output
7520 @subsection Output of Data
7521
7522
7523 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7524 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7525 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7526 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7527 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7528 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7529 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7530 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7531 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7532 These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7533 of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7534 byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7535 aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7536 @code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7537
7538 The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7539 followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7540 the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7541 @end deftypevr
7542
7543 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
7544 The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7545 integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7546 in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7547 function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7548 object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7549 split the object into smaller parts.
7550
7551 The default implementation of this hook will use the
7552 @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7553 when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7554 @end deftypefn
7555
7556 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECL_END (void)
7557 Define this hook if the target assembler requires a special marker to
7558 terminate an initialized variable declaration.
7559 @end deftypefn
7560
7561 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{x})
7562 A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7563 can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7564 the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7565 @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7566
7567 If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7568 so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7569 itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7570 return @code{true}.
7571 @end deftypefn
7572
7573 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7574 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7575 instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7576 bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7577 @code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7578
7579 If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7580 Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7581 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7582 @end defmac
7583
7584 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7585 A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7586 @var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7587 is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7588 @end defmac
7589
7590 @defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7591 You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
7592 expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7593 pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7594 GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7595 not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7596 pool before the function.
7597 @end defmac
7598
7599 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7600 A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7601 constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7602 the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7603 be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7604 is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7605 immediately after this call.
7606
7607 If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7608 not be defined.
7609 @end defmac
7610
7611 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7612 A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7613 constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7614 anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7615
7616 The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7617 assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7618 output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7619 @samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7620 @var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7621 alignment.
7622
7623 The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7624 the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7625 responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7626 Here is how to do this:
7627
7628 @smallexample
7629 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7630 @end smallexample
7631
7632 When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7633 @code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7634 entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7635
7636 You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7637 @end defmac
7638
7639 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7640 A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7641 pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7642 function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7643 obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7644 constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7645
7646 If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7647 define this macro.
7648 @end defmac
7649
7650 @defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7651 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7652 used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7653 to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7654 a line separator uses multiple characters.
7655
7656 If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7657 the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7658 @end defmac
7659
7660 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7661 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
7662 These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7663 assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7664 default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7665 @end deftypevr
7666
7667 These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7668 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7669
7670 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7671 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7672 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7673 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7674 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7675 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7676 These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7677 target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7678 the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7679 @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7680 simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7681 @code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7682 by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7683 it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
7684 32 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7685 on the host machine.
7686
7687 The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7688 using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7689 machine's memory.
7690 @end defmac
7691
7692 @node Uninitialized Data
7693 @subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7694
7695 Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7696 outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7697
7698 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7699 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7700 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7701 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7702 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7703 possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7704 other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7705 backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7706 byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7707 equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7708 the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7709 an ordinary undefined external.
7710
7711 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7712 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7713 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7714
7715 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7716 common global variables are output.
7717 @end defmac
7718
7719 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7720 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7721 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7722 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7723 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7724 as the number of bits.
7725 @end defmac
7726
7727 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7728 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7729 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7730 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7731 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7732 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7733 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7734 @end defmac
7735
7736 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7737 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7738 @var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
7739 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment}
7740 is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
7741
7742 Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7743 @file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
7744 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7745 before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7746 the name, and a newline.
7747
7748 There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro.
7749 The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7750 switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7751 You do not need to do both.
7752
7753 Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7754 non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7755 efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7756 not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7757 common in order to save space in the object file.
7758 @end defmac
7759
7760 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7761 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7762 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7763 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7764 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7765
7766 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7767 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7768 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7769
7770 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7771 static variables are output.
7772 @end defmac
7773
7774 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7775 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7776 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7777 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7778 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7779 as the number of bits.
7780 @end defmac
7781
7782 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7783 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7784 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7785 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7786 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7787 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7788 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7789 @end defmac
7790
7791 @node Label Output
7792 @subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7793
7794 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7795 This is about outputting labels.
7796
7797 @findex assemble_name
7798 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7799 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7800 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7801 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7802 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7803 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7804 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7805 @end defmac
7806
7807 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7808 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7809 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7810 a function.
7811 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7812 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7813 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7814 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7815
7816 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7817 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7818 @end defmac
7819
7820 @findex assemble_name_raw
7821 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7822 Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
7823 to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7824 @code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7825 that it is more efficient.
7826 @end defmac
7827
7828 @defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
7829 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7830 size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7831 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7832 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7833
7834 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7835 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7836 for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7837 macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7838 define this macro.
7839 @end defmac
7840
7841 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
7842 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7843 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7844 symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7845 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7846 provided.
7847 @end defmac
7848
7849 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7850 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7851 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
7852 the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
7853 address.
7854
7855 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7856 provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7857 @samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7858 the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7859 not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7860 to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
7861 @end defmac
7862
7863 @defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
7864 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
7865 @samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
7866 G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
7867 @samp{.} is used instead.
7868 @end defmac
7869
7870 @defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
7871 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
7872 @samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
7873 have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
7874 are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
7875 @end defmac
7876
7877 @defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
7878 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7879 type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7880 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7881 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7882
7883 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7884 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7885 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7886 types at all, do not define this macro.
7887 @end defmac
7888
7889 @defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
7890 A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7891 the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7892 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7893 the default is not to define this macro.
7894
7895 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7896 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7897 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7898 types at all, do not define this macro.
7899 @end defmac
7900
7901 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7902 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7903 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7904 symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7905 that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7906 you should not count on this.
7907
7908 If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7909 definition of this macro is provided.
7910 @end defmac
7911
7912 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7913 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7914 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7915 function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
7916 outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7917 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
7918 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7919
7920 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7921 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
7922
7923 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7924 of this macro.
7925 @end defmac
7926
7927 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7928 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7929 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7930 which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7931 function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7932 representing the function.
7933
7934 If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7935
7936 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7937 of this macro.
7938 @end defmac
7939
7940 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_COLD_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7941 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7942 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7943 cold function partition which is being defined. This macro is responsible
7944 for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7945 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
7946 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7947
7948 If this macro is not defined, then the cold partition name is defined in the
7949 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7950
7951 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7952 of this macro.
7953 @end defmac
7954
7955 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_COLD_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7956 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7957 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a cold function
7958 partition which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7959 cold partition of the function. The argument @var{decl} is the
7960 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7961
7962 If this macro is not defined, then the partition size is not defined.
7963
7964 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7965 of this macro.
7966 @end defmac
7967
7968 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7969 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7970 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7971 initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
7972 label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
7973 @var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7974
7975 If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7976 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7977
7978 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7979 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
7980 @end defmac
7981
7982 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{expr}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
7983 A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7984 for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
7985 target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7986 @code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7987 and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
7988 will be an internal label.
7989
7990 The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7991 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
7992
7993 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7994 @end deftypefn
7995
7996 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
7997 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7998 @var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7999 for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
8000
8001 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
8002 nothing.
8003 @end defmac
8004
8005 @defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
8006 A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
8007 once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
8008 chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
8009 initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
8010 something about the size of the object.
8011
8012 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
8013 nothing.
8014
8015 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
8016 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
8017 @end defmac
8018
8019 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name})
8020 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8021 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
8022 that is, available for reference from other files.
8023
8024 The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
8025 @code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
8026 @end deftypefn
8027
8028 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl})
8029 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8030 @var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
8031 global; that is, available for reference from other files.
8032
8033 The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
8034 @end deftypefn
8035
8036 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_UNDEFINED_DECL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{decl})
8037 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8038 @var{stream} some commands that will declare the name associated with
8039 @var{decl} which is not defined in the current translation unit. Most
8040 assemblers do not require anything to be output in this case.
8041 @end deftypefn
8042
8043 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8044 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8045 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
8046 that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
8047 no other definition is available. Use the expression
8048 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
8049 itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
8050 for making that name weak, and a newline.
8051
8052 If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
8053 support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
8054 macro.
8055 @end defmac
8056
8057 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8058 Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
8059 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
8060 or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
8061 should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
8062 defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8063 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
8064 to make @var{name} weak.
8065 @end defmac
8066
8067 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8068 Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
8069 symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
8070 declaration of @code{name}.
8071 @end defmac
8072
8073 @defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
8074 A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
8075 supports weak symbols.
8076
8077 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8078 definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
8079 is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
8080 @end defmac
8081
8082 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
8083 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
8084
8085 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8086 definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
8087 this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
8088 flag such as @option{-melf}.
8089 @end defmac
8090
8091 @defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
8092 A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
8093 public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
8094 be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
8095 format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
8096 section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
8097 requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
8098 @end defmac
8099
8100 @defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
8101 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
8102 semantics.
8103
8104 If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
8105 definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
8106 definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
8107 you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
8108 setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
8109 be emitted as one-only.
8110 @end defmac
8111
8112 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, int @var{visibility})
8113 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
8114 commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
8115 hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
8116 @end deftypefn
8117
8118 @defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
8119 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
8120 that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
8121 The default is @code{0}.
8122
8123 Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
8124 if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
8125 will have undefined references from other translation units, that
8126 symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
8127 thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
8128 (explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
8129 with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
8130
8131 The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
8132 targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
8133 restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
8134 table of contents.
8135 @end defmac
8136
8137 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
8138 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8139 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
8140 symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
8141 not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
8142 declaration.
8143
8144 This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
8145 The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
8146 @end defmac
8147
8148 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (rtx @var{symref})
8149 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8150 pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
8151 library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
8152 @end deftypefn
8153
8154 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED (const char *@var{symbol})
8155 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8156 directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
8157 .no_dead_code_strip directive.
8158 @end deftypefn
8159
8160 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8161 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8162 @var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
8163 @var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
8164 is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
8165 systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
8166 @end defmac
8167
8168 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME (const char *@var{name})
8169 Given a symbol @var{name}, perform same mangling as @code{varasm.c}'s @code{assemble_name}, but in memory rather than to a file stream, returning result as an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE}. Required for correct LTO symtabs. The default implementation calls the @code{TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING} hook and then prepends the @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX}, if any.
8170 @end deftypefn
8171
8172 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
8173 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
8174 @code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
8175 will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
8176 to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
8177 encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
8178 @end defmac
8179
8180 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
8181 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
8182 result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
8183 @code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8184 This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8185 specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
8186 when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8187 being taken.
8188 @end defmac
8189
8190 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno})
8191 A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8192 name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
8193
8194 It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8195 used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8196 will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8197
8198 It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8199 object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8200 should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8201 beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8202 convention your system uses, and follow it.
8203
8204 The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8205 @end deftypefn
8206
8207 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8208 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8209 label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8210 @var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8211 may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8212 systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8213 bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8214 bundles.
8215
8216 If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8217 used.
8218 @end defmac
8219
8220 @defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8221 A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8222 is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8223
8224 This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8225 produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8226 with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8227
8228 If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8229 output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8230 @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8231 string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8232 to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8233 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8234 you should know what it does on your machine.)
8235 @end defmac
8236
8237 @defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8238 A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8239 @code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8240 @var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8241 added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8242
8243 The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8244 produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8245 @var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8246 assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8247 macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8248 internal static variables in different scopes.
8249
8250 Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8251 conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8252 or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8253 between the name and the number will suffice.
8254
8255 If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8256 which is correct for most systems.
8257 @end defmac
8258
8259 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8260 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8261 which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8262
8263 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8264 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8265 correct for most systems.
8266 @end defmac
8267
8268 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8269 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8270 which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8271 to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8272 be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8273 the tree nodes are available.
8274
8275 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8276 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8277 correct for most systems.
8278 @end defmac
8279
8280 @defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8281 A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8282 (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8283 of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8284 current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8285 This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8286 @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8287 @end defmac
8288
8289 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8290 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8291 which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8292 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8293 an undefined weak symbol.
8294
8295 Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8296 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8297 @end defmac
8298
8299 @defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8300 Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8301 Objective-C methods.
8302
8303 The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8304 class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8305 the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8306 @samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8307
8308 These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8309 the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8310 systems define other ways of computing names.
8311
8312 @var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8313 buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8314 @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
8315 50 characters extra.
8316
8317 The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8318 method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8319 @var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8320 in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8321
8322 On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8323 macro to provide more human-readable names.
8324 @end defmac
8325
8326 @node Initialization
8327 @subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8328 @cindex initialization routines
8329 @cindex termination routines
8330 @cindex constructors, output of
8331 @cindex destructors, output of
8332
8333 The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8334 (also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8335 data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8336 to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8337 @code{main} is called.
8338
8339 Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8340 @dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8341 terminates.
8342
8343 To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8344 must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8345 be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8346 system, you need to specify how to do this.
8347
8348 There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8349 initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8350 Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8351
8352 @findex __CTOR_LIST__
8353 @findex __DTOR_LIST__
8354 The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8355 initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8356 termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8357
8358 Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
8359 0, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8360 the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8361 pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8362 pointer containing zero.
8363
8364 Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8365 @file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8366 time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8367 list; destructors in forward order.
8368
8369 The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8370 formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8371 aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8372 Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8373 object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8374 the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8375 accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8376 Termination functions are handled similarly.
8377
8378 This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8379 @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8380 support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8381 constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8382 and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8383
8384 When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8385 upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8386 support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8387 parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8388 program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8389
8390 @smallexample
8391 ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8392 @end smallexample
8393
8394 The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8395 section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8396 for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8397 files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8398 are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8399
8400 The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8401 compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8402 fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8403 to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8404 of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8405 that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8406
8407 To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8408 macro properly.
8409
8410 If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8411 @code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8412 entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8413 it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8414 after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8415 in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8416
8417 In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8418 two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8419 and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8420 @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8421 entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8422 and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8423 code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8424 the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8425 placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8426 a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8427 @code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8428 section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8429 the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8430 the initialization process.
8431
8432 The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8433 This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8434 file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8435 this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8436 termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8437 an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8438 pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8439 the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8440 initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8441 via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8442 @code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8443
8444 @ifinfo
8445 The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8446 customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8447 @end ifinfo
8448
8449 @node Macros for Initialization
8450 @subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8451
8452 Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8453 and termination functions:
8454
8455 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8456 If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8457 operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8458 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8459 using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8460 macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8461 run the initialization functions.
8462 @end defmac
8463
8464 @defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8465 If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8466 This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8467 on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8468 be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8469 @end defmac
8470
8471 @defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8472 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8473 the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8474 @end defmac
8475
8476 @defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8477 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8478 the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8479 @end defmac
8480
8481 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8482 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8483 automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8484 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8485 the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8486 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8487
8488 This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8489 shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8490 exception tables embedded in the code.
8491 @end defmac
8492
8493 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8494 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8495 automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8496 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8497 the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8498 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8499 @end defmac
8500
8501 @defmac INVOKE__main
8502 If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8503 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8504 where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8505 useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8506 @end defmac
8507
8508 @defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8509 If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8510 compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8511 of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8512 encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8513 @end defmac
8514
8515 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8516 This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8517 collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8518 It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8519 @end deftypevr
8520
8521 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8522 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8523 the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8524
8525 Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8526 no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8527 priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8528 otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8529
8530 If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8531 be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8532 target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8533 is not defined.
8534 @end deftypefn
8535
8536 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8537 This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8538 functions rather than initialization functions.
8539 @end deftypefn
8540
8541 If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8542 generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8543
8544 If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8545 constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8546 an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8547
8548 On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8549 @command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8550
8551 @defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8552 Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8553 object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8554 object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8555
8556 This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8557 part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8558 @end defmac
8559
8560 @defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8561 Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8562 to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8563 @command{nm}.
8564 @end defmac
8565
8566 @defmac NM_FLAGS
8567 @command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8568 constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
8569 passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
8570 are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
8571 produces.
8572 @end defmac
8573
8574 If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8575 dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8576 these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8577 termination functions in shared libraries:
8578
8579 @defmac LDD_SUFFIX
8580 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
8581 which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
8582 @end defmac
8583
8584 @defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8585 Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8586 of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
8587 of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8588 from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8589 code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8590 line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8591 @end defmac
8592
8593 @defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8594 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8595 library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8596 strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8597 constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8598 that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8599 @end defmac
8600
8601 @node Instruction Output
8602 @subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8603
8604 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8605 This describes assembler instruction output.
8606
8607 @defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8608 A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8609 registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8610 register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8611 @end defmac
8612
8613 @defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8614 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8615 and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8616 registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8617 to registers using alternate names.
8618 @end defmac
8619
8620 @defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8621 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8622 name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8623 machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
8624 names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8625 declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
8626 @code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8627 register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8628
8629 This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8630 @code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8631 register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8632 VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8633 ``s0'' and ``s1''.
8634 @end defmac
8635
8636 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8637 Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8638 requires different names for the machine instructions.
8639
8640 The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8641 assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8642 macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8643 points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8644 written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8645 opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8646 increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8647 so that it will not be output twice.
8648
8649 In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8650 name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8651 that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8652 care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8653 @var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8654
8655 @findex recog_data.operand
8656 If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8657 elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8658
8659 If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8660 in the usual way.
8661 @end defmac
8662
8663 @defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8664 If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8665 assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8666 they will be output differently.
8667
8668 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8669 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8670 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8671 The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8672 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8673 by changing the contents of the vector.
8674
8675 This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8676 file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8677 can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8678 as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8679 syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8680 writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8681
8682 If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8683 @end defmac
8684
8685 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN (FILE *@var{file}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx *@var{opvec}, int @var{noperands})
8686 If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8687 output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8688 if necessary.
8689
8690 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8691 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8692 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8693 The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8694 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8695 by checking the contents of the vector.
8696 @end deftypefn
8697
8698 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8699 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8700 assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8701 RTL expression.
8702
8703 @var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8704 of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8705 printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8706 the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8707 operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8708 @var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8709 @var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8710
8711 @findex reg_names
8712 If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8713 The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8714 @code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8715 @code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8716
8717 When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8718 (a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8719 with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8720 @var{code}.
8721 @end defmac
8722
8723 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8724 A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8725 punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8726 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8727 punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8728 in this way.
8729 @end defmac
8730
8731 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8732 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8733 assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8734 whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8735
8736 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8737 On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8738 section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8739 @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8740 @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8741 Format}.
8742 @end defmac
8743
8744 @findex dbr_sequence_length
8745 @defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8746 A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8747 been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8748 determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8749 currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8750 or whatever.
8751
8752 Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8753 reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
8754 explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
8755 @end defmac
8756
8757 @findex final_sequence
8758 Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
8759 prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8760 (i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
8761 found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8762 processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8763 being output.
8764
8765 @findex asm_fprintf
8766 @defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8767 @defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8768 @defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8769 @defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
8770 If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8771 @samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8772 @file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8773 support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8774 files can define these macros differently.
8775 @end defmac
8776
8777 @defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
8778 If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
8779 statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8780 the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8781 printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
8782 statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
8783 generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8784 specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8785 The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8786 string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8787 upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
8788 @end defmac
8789
8790 @defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
8791 If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8792 different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8793 numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8794 first variant.
8795
8796 If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
8797 @smallexample
8798 @samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
8799 @end smallexample
8800 @noindent
8801 in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8802 first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8803 @samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8804 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8805 within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8806 alternatives within the braces than the value of
8807 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing. If it's needed
8808 to print curly braces or @samp{|} character in assembler output directly,
8809 @samp{%@{}, @samp{%@}} and @samp{%|} can be used.
8810
8811 If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8812 @samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8813 operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8814
8815 Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8816 @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
8817 the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
8818 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8819 if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8820 opcodes or operand order.
8821 @end defmac
8822
8823 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8824 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8825 which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8826 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8827 profiling.
8828 @end defmac
8829
8830 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8831 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8832 which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8833 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8834 profiling.
8835 @end defmac
8836
8837 @node Dispatch Tables
8838 @subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8839
8840 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8841 This concerns dispatch tables.
8842
8843 @cindex dispatch table
8844 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
8845 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8846 pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8847 @var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8848 definitions of these labels are output using
8849 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
8850 way here. For example,
8851
8852 @smallexample
8853 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8854 @var{value}, @var{rel})
8855 @end smallexample
8856
8857 You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
8858 dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
8859 will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
8860 @var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
8861 mode and flags can be read.
8862 @end defmac
8863
8864 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
8865 This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8866 in a dispatch table are absolute.
8867
8868 The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8869 @var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8870 a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
8871 definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8872 For example,
8873
8874 @smallexample
8875 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
8876 @end smallexample
8877 @end defmac
8878
8879 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8880 Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8881 specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
8882 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
8883 jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_table_data} containing an
8884 @code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8885
8886 This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8887 for the table.
8888
8889 If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
8890 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8891 @end defmac
8892
8893 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8894 Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8895 jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8896 after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8897 the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8898 @var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8899 of the preceding label.
8900
8901 If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8902 the jump-table.
8903 @end defmac
8904
8905 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl}, int @var{for_eh}, int @var{empty})
8906 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
8907 should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8908 should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8909 function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
8910 The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8911 exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8912 true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
8913
8914 The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8915 @end deftypefn
8916
8917 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream})
8918 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8919 It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8920 to be broken up according to function.
8921
8922 The default is that no label is emitted.
8923 @end deftypefn
8924
8925 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY (rtx @var{personality})
8926 If the target implements @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT}, this hook may be used to emit a directive to install a personality hook into the unwind info. This hook should not be used if dwarf2 unwind info is used.
8927 @end deftypefn
8928
8929 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT (FILE *@var{stream}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
8930 This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
8931 given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
8932 returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
8933 @end deftypefn
8934
8935 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
8936 True if the @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT} hook should be called before the assembly for @var{insn} has been emitted, false if the hook should be called afterward.
8937 @end deftypevr
8938
8939 @node Exception Region Output
8940 @subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8941
8942 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8943
8944 This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8945 region.
8946
8947 @defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
8948 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8949 exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
8950 provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8951 @file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
8952
8953 You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8954 unwind information and the default definition does not work.
8955 @end defmac
8956
8957 @defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
8958 If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8959 data section even though the target supports named sections. This
8960 might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8961 collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8962
8963 Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8964 also defined.
8965 @end defmac
8966
8967 @defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8968 Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8969 information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8970 runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8971 and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8972 @end defmac
8973
8974 @defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
8975 An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
8976 that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
8977 @end defmac
8978
8979 @defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
8980 Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8981 information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8982 Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
8983 @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}),
8984 GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
8985 @end defmac
8986
8987 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
8988 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
8989 by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
8990 should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
8991 @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
8992 should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8993 information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
8994
8995 A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
8996 This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
8997 default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
8998
8999 Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
9000 not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
9001 @var{opts}. In particular, the
9002 setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
9003 macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
9004 depending on this setting.
9005
9006 The default implementation of the hook first honors the
9007 @option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
9008 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
9009 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
9010 must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
9011 @end deftypefn
9012
9013 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
9014 This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
9015 tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
9016 command-line option processing.
9017 @end deftypevr
9018
9019 @defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
9020 Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
9021 should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
9022 instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
9023 @end defmac
9024
9025 @defmac JMP_BUF_SIZE
9026 This macro has no effect unless @code{DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP} is also
9027 defined. Define this macro if the default size of @code{jmp_buf} buffer
9028 for the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism
9029 is not large enough, or if it is much too large.
9030 The default size is @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER * sizeof(void *)}.
9031 @end defmac
9032
9033 @defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
9034 This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
9035 function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
9036 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
9037 alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is true, and the positive
9038 minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
9039 the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
9040 @end defmac
9041
9042 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
9043 Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
9044 end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
9045 Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
9046 true otherwise.
9047 @end deftypevr
9048
9049 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN (rtx @var{reg})
9050 Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
9051 represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
9052 register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
9053 locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
9054 register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
9055 If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
9056 @end deftypefn
9057
9058 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_DWARF_FRAME_REG_MODE (int @var{regno})
9059 Given a register, this hook should return the mode which the
9060 corresponding Dwarf frame register should have. This is normally
9061 used to return a smaller mode than the raw mode to prevent call
9062 clobbered parts of a register altering the frame register size
9063 @end deftypefn
9064
9065 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA (tree @var{address})
9066 If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
9067 multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
9068 sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
9069 It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
9070 filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
9071 @var{address} is the address of the table.
9072 @end deftypefn
9073
9074 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_TTYPE (rtx @var{sym})
9075 This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
9076 the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
9077 if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
9078 reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
9079 @end deftypefn
9080
9081 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
9082 This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
9083 based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
9084 the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
9085 running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
9086 @end deftypevr
9087
9088 @node Alignment Output
9089 @subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
9090
9091 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9092 This describes commands for alignment.
9093
9094 @defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9095 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
9096 a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
9097
9098 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9099 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9100 define the macro.
9101
9102 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9103 to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
9104 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9105 selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
9106 @end defmac
9107
9108 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
9109 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9110 @code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
9111 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9112 @end deftypefn
9113
9114 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
9115 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
9116 a @code{BARRIER}.
9117
9118 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9119 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9120 define the macro.
9121 @end defmac
9122
9123 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
9124 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9125 @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
9126 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9127 @end deftypefn
9128
9129 @defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9130 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label} that heads
9131 a frequently executed basic block (usually the header of a loop).
9132
9133 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9134 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9135 define the macro.
9136
9137 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9138 to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
9139 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9140 selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
9141 @end defmac
9142
9143 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
9144 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
9145 @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
9146 defined.
9147 @end deftypefn
9148
9149 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
9150 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
9151 If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
9152 the maximum of the specified values is used.
9153
9154 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9155 to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
9156 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9157 selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
9158 @end defmac
9159
9160 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
9161 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
9162 to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
9163 is defined.
9164 @end deftypefn
9165
9166 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
9167 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9168 instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
9169 Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
9170 expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
9171 @end defmac
9172
9173 @defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
9174 Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
9175 text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
9176 This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
9177 produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
9178 section.
9179 @end defmac
9180
9181 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9182 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9183 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9184 @var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
9185 @end defmac
9186
9187 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9188 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
9189 for padding, if necessary.
9190 @end defmac
9191
9192 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
9193 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9194 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9195 @var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9196 satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9197 a C expression of type @code{int}.
9198 @end defmac
9199
9200 @need 3000
9201 @node Debugging Info
9202 @section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9203
9204 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9205 This describes how to specify debugging information.
9206
9207 @menu
9208 * All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9209 * DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9210 * DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9211 * File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9212 * SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
9213 * VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
9214 @end menu
9215
9216 @node All Debuggers
9217 @subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9218
9219 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9220 These macros affect all debugging formats.
9221
9222 @defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9223 A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9224 register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9225 of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9226 some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9227 versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9228 compiler and another for DBX@.
9229
9230 If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9231 used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9232 consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9233 Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9234 expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9235
9236 If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9237 does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9238 redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9239 @end defmac
9240
9241 @defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9242 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9243 variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9244 computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9245 gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9246 that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9247 for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9248 @option{-g} options is used.
9249 @end defmac
9250
9251 @defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9252 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9253 having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9254 @var{offset}.
9255 @end defmac
9256
9257 @defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9258 A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9259 produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9260 this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9261 debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9262 @code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9263 @code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9264
9265 When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9266 value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9267 exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9268 value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9269 defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9270
9271 The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9272 user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9273 @option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9274 @end defmac
9275
9276 @node DBX Options
9277 @subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9278
9279 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9280 These are specific options for DBX output.
9281
9282 @defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9283 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9284 in response to the @option{-g} option.
9285 @end defmac
9286
9287 @defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9288 Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9289 in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9290 @end defmac
9291
9292 @defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9293 Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9294 GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9295 debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9296 macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9297 if there is any occasion to.
9298 @end defmac
9299
9300 @defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9301 Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9302 in the text section.
9303 @end defmac
9304
9305 @defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9306 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9307 use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9308 If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9309 applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9310 @end defmac
9311
9312 @defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9313 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9314 use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9315 value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9316 @code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9317 information format.
9318 @end defmac
9319
9320 @defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9321 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9322 use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9323 name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9324 macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9325 @end defmac
9326
9327 @defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9328 Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9329 @samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9330 describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9331 On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9332 @end defmac
9333
9334 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9335 A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9336 continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9337 exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9338 operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9339 must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9340 with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9341 defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9342 @end defmac
9343
9344 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9345 Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9346 the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9347 a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9348 constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9349 if backslash is correct for your system.
9350 @end defmac
9351
9352 @defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9353 Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9354 outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9355 variable.
9356 @end defmac
9357
9358 @defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9359 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9360 for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9361 @end defmac
9362
9363 @defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9364 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9365 for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9366 provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9367 @end defmac
9368
9369 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9370 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9371 for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9372 ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9373 @end defmac
9374
9375 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9376 The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9377 passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9378 do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9379 @end defmac
9380
9381 @defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9382 Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9383 arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9384 in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9385 code.
9386 @end defmac
9387
9388 @defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9389 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9390 the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9391 relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9392 an absolute address.
9393 @end defmac
9394
9395 @defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9396 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9397 the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9398 start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9399 @end defmac
9400
9401 @defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9402 Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9403 @code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9404 macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9405 number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9406 generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9407 number for a type number.
9408 @end defmac
9409
9410 @node DBX Hooks
9411 @subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9412
9413 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9414 These are hooks for DBX format.
9415
9416 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9417 A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9418 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9419 @var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9420 invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9421 unique labels in the assembly output.
9422
9423 This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9424 if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9425 @end defmac
9426
9427 @defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9428 Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9429 @code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9430 On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9431 disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9432 @end defmac
9433
9434 @defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9435 Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9436 extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9437 feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9438 @end defmac
9439
9440 @node File Names and DBX
9441 @subsection File Names in DBX Format
9442
9443 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9444 This describes file names in DBX format.
9445
9446 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9447 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9448 @var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9449 file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9450 This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9451
9452 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9453 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9454
9455 It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9456 text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9457 to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9458 @var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9459 @end defmac
9460
9461 @defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9462 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9463 of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9464 the beginning of the file.
9465 @end defmac
9466
9467 @defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9468 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9469 that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9470 an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9471 @samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9472 @end defmac
9473
9474 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9475 A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9476 compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9477 written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9478
9479 If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9480 of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9481 @end defmac
9482
9483 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9484 Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9485 @code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9486 the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9487 whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9488 @end defmac
9489
9490 @need 2000
9491 @node SDB and DWARF
9492 @subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9493
9494 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9495 Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9496
9497 @defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9498 Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9499 for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9500 @end defmac
9501
9502 @defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9503 Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9504 debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9505
9506 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION (const_tree @var{function})
9507 Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9508 be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9509 value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9510 @end deftypefn
9511
9512 To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9513 define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9514 @code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9515 prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9516 as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9517 @end defmac
9518
9519 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9520 Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
9521 Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9522 (@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9523 exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9524 how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
9525 @end defmac
9526
9527 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO (void)
9528 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9529 unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9530 @code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9531 return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9532
9533 A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9534 is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9535
9536 A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9537 This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9538 @end deftypefn
9539
9540 @defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9541 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9542 line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9543 tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9544 @end defmac
9545
9546 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9547 True if the @code{.debug_pubtypes} and @code{.debug_pubnames} sections should be emitted. These sections are not used on most platforms, and in particular GDB does not use them.
9548 @end deftypevr
9549
9550 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FORCE_AT_COMP_DIR
9551 True if the @code{DW_AT_comp_dir} attribute should be emitted for each compilation unit. This attribute is required for the darwin linker to emit debug information.
9552 @end deftypevr
9553
9554 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
9555 True if sched2 is not to be run at its normal place.
9556 This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9557 @end deftypevr
9558
9559 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
9560 True if vartrack is not to be run at its normal place.
9561 This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9562 @end deftypevr
9563
9564 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NO_REGISTER_ALLOCATION
9565 True if register allocation and the passes
9566 following it should not be run. Usually true only for virtual assembler
9567 targets.
9568 @end deftypevr
9569
9570 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9571 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9572 @var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9573 @end defmac
9574
9575 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9576 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9577 between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9578 slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9579 @end defmac
9580
9581 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
9582 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9583 section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9584 given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
9585 @end defmac
9586
9587 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9588 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9589 reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9590 @end defmac
9591
9592 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9593 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9594 the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9595 is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9596 is referenced by a function.
9597 @end defmac
9598
9599 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{size}, rtx @var{x})
9600 If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9601 reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9602 @end deftypefn
9603
9604 @defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9605 Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9606 SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9607 macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9608 not define them yourself.
9609 @end defmac
9610
9611 @defmac SDB_DELIM
9612 Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9613 SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9614 delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9615 a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9616 required.
9617 @end defmac
9618
9619 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9620 Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9621 union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9622 allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9623 it.
9624 @end defmac
9625
9626 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9627 Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9628 enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9629 assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9630 @end defmac
9631
9632 @defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9633 A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9634 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9635 @var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9636 @end defmac
9637
9638 @need 2000
9639 @node VMS Debug
9640 @subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9641
9642 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9643 Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9644
9645 @defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9646 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9647 in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9648 is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9649 @option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
9650 behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
9651 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9652 @end defmac
9653
9654 @node Floating Point
9655 @section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9656 @cindex cross compilation and floating point
9657 @cindex floating point and cross compilation
9658
9659 While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9660 there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9661 means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9662 in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9663 doing the compilation.
9664
9665 Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9666 range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9667 the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9668 safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9669 the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9670 emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9671 target floating point formats are identical.
9672
9673 The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9674 use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9675 floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9676 their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9677
9678 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9679 The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9680 machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9681 array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9682 quantity.
9683 @end defmac
9684
9685 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9686 Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
9687 floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9688 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9689 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9690 @end deftypefn
9691
9692 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9693 Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9694 @end deftypefn
9695
9696 @deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9697 Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9698 @end deftypefn
9699
9700 @deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9701 Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9702 @var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9703 @end deftypefn
9704
9705 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, machine_mode @var{mode})
9706 Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9707 representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9708 decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9709 defined by the C language for both.
9710 @end deftypefn
9711
9712 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9713 Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9714 @end deftypefn
9715
9716 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9717 Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9718 @end deftypefn
9719
9720 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9721 Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9722 @end deftypefn
9723
9724 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9725 Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9726 @var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9727 variable).
9728
9729 The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
9730 following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9731 @code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9732
9733 If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9734 target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9735 @code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
9736 @code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
9737 @end deftypefn
9738
9739 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9740 Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9741 @end deftypefn
9742
9743 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9744 Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9745 @end deftypefn
9746
9747 @node Mode Switching
9748 @section Mode Switching Instructions
9749 @cindex mode switching
9750 The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9751
9752 @defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9753 Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9754 switching in an optimizing compilation.
9755
9756 For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9757 floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9758 the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9759 operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9760 purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9761 be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9762 or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9763
9764 You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9765 which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9766 return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9767 If you define this macro, you also have to define
9768 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{TARGET_MODE_NEEDED},
9769 @code{TARGET_MODE_PRIORITY} and @code{TARGET_MODE_EMIT}.
9770 @code{TARGET_MODE_AFTER}, @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT}
9771 are optional.
9772 @end defmac
9773
9774 @defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9775 If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9776 initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9777 N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9778 of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
9779 The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9780 zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9781 entity in question.
9782 In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
9783 represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9784 switch is needed / supplied.
9785 @end defmac
9786
9787 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MODE_EMIT (int @var{entity}, int @var{mode}, int @var{prev_mode}, HARD_REG_SET @var{regs_live})
9788 Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}. @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where the insn(s) are to be inserted. @var{prev_moxde} indicates the mode to switch from. Sets of a lower numbered entity will be emitted before sets of a higher numbered entity to a mode of the same or lower priority.
9789 @end deftypefn
9790
9791 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_NEEDED (int @var{entity}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
9792 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
9793 @end deftypefn
9794
9795 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_AFTER (int @var{entity}, int @var{mode}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
9796 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if different from the incoming mode).
9797 @end deftypefn
9798
9799 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_ENTRY (int @var{entity})
9800 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9801 @end deftypefn
9802
9803 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_EXIT (int @var{entity})
9804 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9805 @end deftypefn
9806
9807 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_PRIORITY (int @var{entity}, int @var{n})
9808 This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed. 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority} (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{} @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9809 @end deftypefn
9810
9811 @node Target Attributes
9812 @section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9813 @cindex target attributes
9814 @cindex machine attributes
9815 @cindex attributes, target-specific
9816
9817 Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9818 These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9819 be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9820
9821 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9822 If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9823 attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree-core.h}) specifying the machine
9824 specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9825 entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9826 take.
9827 @end deftypevr
9828
9829 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P (const_tree @var{name})
9830 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9831 machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9832 given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9833 subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9834 false for all machine-specific attributes.
9835 @end deftypefn
9836
9837 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
9838 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9839 @var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9840 and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9841 generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9842 supposed always to be compatible.
9843 @end deftypefn
9844
9845 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
9846 If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
9847 the newly defined @var{type}.
9848 @end deftypefn
9849
9850 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
9851 Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9852 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9853 @code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9854 that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9855 function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9856 merging.
9857 @end deftypefn
9858
9859 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
9860 Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9861 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9862 @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9863 @var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9864 when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9865 attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9866 call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9867
9868 @findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9869 If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9870 for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9871 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9872 will then define a function called
9873 @code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9874 the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9875 add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9876 to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9877 @samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9878 @file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
9879 @end deftypefn
9880
9881 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P (const_tree @var{decl})
9882 @var{decl} is a variable or function with @code{__attribute__((dllimport))} specified. Use this hook if the target needs to add extra validation checks to @code{handle_dll_attribute}.
9883 @end deftypefn
9884
9885 @defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
9886 Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
9887 @code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9888 default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9889 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9890 of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9891 on this implementation detail.
9892 @end defmac
9893
9894 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
9895 Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9896 when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9897 wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9898 the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9899 created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9900 for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9901 shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9902 the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9903 attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9904 needed.
9905 @end deftypefn
9906
9907 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (const_tree @var{fndecl})
9908 @cindex inlining
9909 This target hook returns @code{true} if it is OK to inline @var{fndecl}
9910 into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9911 attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9912 target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9913 @end deftypefn
9914
9915 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{name}, tree @var{args}, int @var{flags})
9916 This hook is called to parse @code{attribute(target("..."))}, which
9917 allows setting target-specific options on individual functions.
9918 These function-specific options may differ
9919 from the options specified on the command line. The hook should return
9920 @code{true} if the options are valid.
9921
9922 The hook should set the @code{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9923 the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target-specific
9924 @code{struct cl_target_option} structure.
9925 @end deftypefn
9926
9927 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_SAVE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
9928 This hook is called to save any additional target-specific information
9929 in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for function-specific
9930 options from the @code{struct gcc_options} structure.
9931 @xref{Option file format}.
9932 @end deftypefn
9933
9934 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9935 This hook is called to restore any additional target-specific
9936 information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9937 function-specific options to the @code{struct gcc_options} structure.
9938 @end deftypefn
9939
9940 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_POST_STREAM_IN (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9941 This hook is called to update target-specific information in the
9942 @code{struct cl_target_option} structure after it is streamed in from
9943 LTO bytecode.
9944 @end deftypefn
9945
9946 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_PRINT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{indent}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9947 This hook is called to print any additional target-specific
9948 information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9949 function-specific options.
9950 @end deftypefn
9951
9952 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE (tree @var{args}, tree @var{pop_target})
9953 This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC target}, which
9954 sets the target-specific options for functions that occur later in the
9955 input stream. The options accepted should be the same as those handled by the
9956 @code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
9957 @end deftypefn
9958
9959 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE (void)
9960 Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9961 a particular target machine. You can override the hook
9962 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
9963 once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9964
9965 Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
9966 @option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
9967
9968 If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9969 changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9970 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9971 @end deftypefn
9972
9973 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_FUNCTION_VERSIONS (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
9974 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are
9975 versions of the same function. @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are function
9976 versions if and only if they have the same function signature and
9977 different target specific attributes, that is, they are compiled for
9978 different target machines.
9979 @end deftypefn
9980
9981 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P (tree @var{caller}, tree @var{callee})
9982 This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9983 cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
9984 default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9985 specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9986 @end deftypefn
9987
9988 @node Emulated TLS
9989 @section Emulating TLS
9990 @cindex Emulated TLS
9991
9992 For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9993 specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9994 used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9995 configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
9996 the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
9997 layer.
9998
9999 The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
10000 object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
10001 which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
10002 address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
10003
10004 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
10005 Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
10006 object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
10007 emulated TLS helper function to be used.
10008 @end deftypevr
10009
10010 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
10011 Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
10012 program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
10013 initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
10014 have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
10015 registration function to be used.
10016 @end deftypevr
10017
10018 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
10019 Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
10020 be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
10021 any section.
10022 @end deftypevr
10023
10024 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
10025 Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
10026 placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
10027 section.
10028 @end deftypevr
10029
10030 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
10031 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
10032 The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
10033 @end deftypevr
10034
10035 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
10036 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
10037 default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
10038 @end deftypevr
10039
10040 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS (tree @var{type}, tree *@var{name})
10041 Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
10042 object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
10043 @var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
10044 @code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
10045 for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
10046 @end deftypefn
10047
10048 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT (tree @var{var}, tree @var{decl}, tree @var{tmpl_addr})
10049 Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
10050 TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
10051 is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
10052 initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
10053 @end deftypefn
10054
10055 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
10056 Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
10057 fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
10058 single objects. The default is false.
10059 @end deftypevr
10060
10061 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
10062 Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
10063 may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
10064 @end deftypevr
10065
10066 @node MIPS Coprocessors
10067 @section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
10068 @cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
10069
10070 The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
10071 coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
10072 accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
10073 and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
10074
10075 @smallexample
10076 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
10077 unsigned int d;
10078
10079 d = cp0count + 3;
10080 @end smallexample
10081
10082 (``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
10083 names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
10084 overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
10085
10086 Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
10087 be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
10088 later in the function.
10089
10090 Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
10091 the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
10092 floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
10093
10094 @node PCH Target
10095 @section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
10096 @cindex parameters, precompiled headers
10097
10098 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY (size_t *@var{sz})
10099 This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
10100 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
10101 @samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
10102 @end deftypefn
10103
10104 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_PCH_VALID_P (const void *@var{data}, size_t @var{sz})
10105 This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
10106 compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
10107 if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
10108 be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
10109
10110 @var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
10111 when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
10112 It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
10113 compiler, so no format checking is needed.
10114
10115 The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
10116 suitable for most targets.
10117 @end deftypefn
10118
10119 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS (int @var{pch_flags})
10120 If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
10121 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
10122 of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
10123 @code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
10124 value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
10125 @end deftypefn
10126
10127 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_PREPARE_PCH_SAVE (void)
10128 Called before writing out a PCH file. If the target has some
10129 garbage-collected data that needs to be in a particular state on PCH loads,
10130 it can use this hook to enforce that state. Very few targets need
10131 to do anything here.
10132 @end deftypefn
10133
10134 @node C++ ABI
10135 @section C++ ABI parameters
10136 @cindex parameters, c++ abi
10137
10138 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE (void)
10139 Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
10140 These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
10141 default is long_long_integer_type_node.
10142 @end deftypefn
10143
10144 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT (void)
10145 This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
10146 @code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
10147 @code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
10148 @end deftypefn
10149
10150 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE (tree @var{type})
10151 This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
10152 whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
10153 known that a cookie is needed. The default is
10154 @code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
10155 IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
10156 @end deftypefn
10157
10158 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE (void)
10159 This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
10160 array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
10161 @end deftypefn
10162
10163 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS (tree @var{type}, int @var{import_export})
10164 If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
10165 class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
10166 will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
10167 to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
10168 modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10169 backend's targeted operating system.
10170 @end deftypefn
10171
10172 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS (void)
10173 This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10174 the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
10175 @code{false}.
10176 @end deftypefn
10177
10178 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE (void)
10179 This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10180 which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10181 table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
10182 Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10183 the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
10184 some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10185 method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10186 @end deftypefn
10187
10188 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl})
10189 @var{decl} is a virtual table, virtual table table, typeinfo object, or other similar implicit class data object that will be emitted with external linkage in this translation unit. No ELF visibility has been explicitly specified. If the target needs to specify a visibility other than that of the containing class, use this hook to set @code{DECL_VISIBILITY} and @code{DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED}.
10190 @end deftypefn
10191
10192 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT (void)
10193 This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10194 similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10195 external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10196 classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10197 unit will not be COMDAT.
10198 @end deftypefn
10199
10200 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT (void)
10201 This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10202 the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10203 be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10204 @end deftypefn
10205
10206 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT (void)
10207 This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10208 should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10209 is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10210 @end deftypefn
10211
10212 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT (void)
10213 This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10214 in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10215 destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10216 shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10217 unloaded. The default is to return false.
10218 @end deftypefn
10219
10220 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION (tree @var{type})
10221 @var{type} is a C++ class (i.e., RECORD_TYPE or UNION_TYPE) that has just been defined. Use this hook to make adjustments to the class (eg, tweak visibility or perform any other required target modifications).
10222 @end deftypefn
10223
10224 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_DECL_MANGLING_CONTEXT (const_tree @var{decl})
10225 Return target-specific mangling context of @var{decl} or @code{NULL_TREE}.
10226 @end deftypefn
10227
10228 @node Named Address Spaces
10229 @section Adding support for named address spaces
10230 @cindex named address spaces
10231
10232 The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10233 standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10234 support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10235 processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10236 GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10237 address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10238 spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10239 @code{const} type attributes.
10240
10241 Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10242 pointers to the generic address space.
10243
10244 For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10245 to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10246 processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10247 issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10248 local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10249 address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10250 @option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10251 always 32 bits).
10252
10253 Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10254 range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10255 address space.
10256
10257 To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10258 the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10259 the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10260 named address space #1:
10261 @smallexample
10262 #define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10263 c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10264 @end smallexample
10265
10266 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10267 Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10268 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10269 The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
10270 generic address space only.
10271 @end deftypefn
10272
10273 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10274 Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10275 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10276 The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10277 generic address space only.
10278 @end deftypefn
10279
10280 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10281 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10282 with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10283 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10284 except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10285 version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10286 @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10287 target hooks for the given address space.
10288 @end deftypefn
10289
10290 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{exp}, bool @var{strict}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10291 Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10292 @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10293 parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10294 finished. This target hook is the same as the
10295 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10296 explicit named address space support.
10297 @end deftypefn
10298
10299 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10300 Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10301 with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10302 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10303 except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10304 @end deftypefn
10305
10306 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P (addr_space_t @var{subset}, addr_space_t @var{superset})
10307 Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10308 contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10309 a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10310 will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10311 arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10312 converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10313 @end deftypefn
10314
10315 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT (rtx @var{op}, tree @var{from_type}, tree @var{to_type})
10316 Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10317 @var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10318 space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10319 to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10320 guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10321 as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10322 @end deftypefn
10323
10324 @node Misc
10325 @section Miscellaneous Parameters
10326 @cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10327
10328 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10329 Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10330
10331 @defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10332 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10333 has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10334 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10335 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10336 set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10337 to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10338 @end defmac
10339
10340 @defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10341 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10342 has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10343 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10344 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10345 set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10346 to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10347 @end defmac
10348
10349 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10350 An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10351 elements of a jump-table should have.
10352 @end defmac
10353
10354 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10355 Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10356 when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10357 it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10358 To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10359 make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10360 The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10361 flags can be updated.
10362 @end defmac
10363
10364 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10365 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10366 should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10367 jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10368 contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10369 is in effect.
10370 @end defmac
10371
10372 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD (void)
10373 This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10374 is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10375 The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10376 five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10377 @end deftypefn
10378
10379 @defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10380 Define this macro to 1 if operations between registers with integral mode
10381 smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10382 Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10383 @end defmac
10384
10385 @defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10386 Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10387 memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10388 bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10389 zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10390 of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10391 insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10392 @code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10393
10394 This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10395 greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10396 value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10397 @code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10398 define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10399
10400 You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10401 the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10402 of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10403 when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10404 integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10405
10406 You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10407 mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10408 @code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10409 is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10410 @end defmac
10411
10412 @defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10413 Define this macro to 1 if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10414 extends.
10415 @end defmac
10416
10417 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL (machine_mode @var{mode})
10418 When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10419 divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10420 the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10421 that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10422 of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10423 has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10424 @end deftypefn
10425
10426 @defmac MOVE_MAX
10427 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10428 between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10429 @end defmac
10430
10431 @defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10432 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10433 between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10434 is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10435 constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10436 at run-time.
10437 @end defmac
10438
10439 @defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10440 A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10441 actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10442 of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
10443 this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10444 a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10445 truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
10446 instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10447 include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10448 also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10449 arguments to bit-field instructions.
10450
10451 If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10452 position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10453 instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10454
10455 However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10456 only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10457 bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10458 such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10459 the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10460
10461 You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10462 @end defmac
10463
10464 @anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10465 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK (machine_mode @var{mode})
10466 This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10467 deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10468 @xref{shift patterns}.
10469
10470 On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10471 shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10472 equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10473 this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10474 otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10475 particular behavior is guaranteed.
10476
10477 Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10478 @emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10479 that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10480
10481 The default implementation of this function returns
10482 @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10483 and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10484 @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10485 nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10486 by overriding it.
10487 @end deftypefn
10488
10489 @defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10490 A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10491 ``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10492 bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10493 operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10494
10495 On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10496
10497 @c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10498 @c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10499 When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10500 modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10501 If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10502 such cases may improve things.
10503 @end defmac
10504
10505 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (machine_mode @var{mode}, machine_mode @var{rep_mode})
10506 The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10507 are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10508 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10509 sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10510 otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10511 representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10512 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10513 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
10514 @var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10515 widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10516
10517 Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10518 value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10519 as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10520 @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10521
10522 Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10523 describe two related properties. If you define
10524 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10525 to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10526 extension.
10527
10528 In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10529 @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10530 @code{mode}.
10531 @end deftypefn
10532
10533 @defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10534 A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10535 with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10536 (@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10537 apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10538 comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10539
10540 A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10541 comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10542 and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10543 which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10544 true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10545 operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10546 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10547 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10548 the compiler.
10549
10550 If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10551 generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10552 replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10553 the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10554 For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10555 @code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10556 @samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10557 expression
10558
10559 @smallexample
10560 (ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10561 @end smallexample
10562
10563 @noindent
10564 can be converted to
10565
10566 @smallexample
10567 (ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10568 @end smallexample
10569
10570 @noindent
10571 where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10572 tested into the sign bit.
10573
10574 There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10575 for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10576 but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
10577 are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10578 perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10579 comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10580
10581 Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10582 from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10583 choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10584 to be used:
10585
10586 @itemize @bullet
10587 @item
10588 Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10589 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10590 ``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10591 comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10592 combine the normalization with other operations.
10593
10594 @item
10595 For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10596 slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10597 other machines.
10598
10599 @item
10600 As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10601 exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10602 others.
10603
10604 @item
10605 Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10606 @end itemize
10607
10608 Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10609 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10610 instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10611 those cases, e.g., one matching
10612
10613 @smallexample
10614 (set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10615 @end smallexample
10616
10617 Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10618 condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10619 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
10620 machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10621 and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10622 @code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
10623 @file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
10624 find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10625
10626 If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10627 not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10628 instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10629 @end defmac
10630
10631 @defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10632 A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10633 returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10634 Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10635 floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10636 this macro.
10637 @end defmac
10638
10639 @defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10640 A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10641 for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10642 mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10643 this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10644 return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10645 this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10646 @code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10647 the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10648 given mode.
10649 @end defmac
10650
10651 @defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10652 @defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10653 A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
10654 for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
10655 A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10656 If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10657 evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10658 entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
10659 the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
10660 In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
10661 this value.
10662
10663 If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10664 @code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10665
10666 This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10667 relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
10668 is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10669 to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10670
10671 Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10672 and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10673 visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10674 to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10675 breaking the API@.
10676 @end defmac
10677
10678 @defmac Pmode
10679 An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10680 this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10681 pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10682 On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10683 modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10684
10685 The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10686 @code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10687 @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10688 to @code{Pmode}.
10689 @end defmac
10690
10691 @defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10692 An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10693 being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
10694 where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
10695 @code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10696 size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10697 as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10698 @end defmac
10699
10700 @defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10701 In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10702 constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10703 hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10704 where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10705 strict conformance to the C Standard.
10706
10707 Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10708 convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10709 files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10710 @end defmac
10711
10712 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_C_PREINCLUDE (void)
10713 Define this hook to return the name of a header file to be included at the start of all compilations, as if it had been included with @code{#include <@var{file}>}. If this hook returns @code{NULL}, or is not defined, or the header is not found, or if the user specifies @option{-ffreestanding} or @option{-nostdinc}, no header is included.
10714
10715 This hook can be used together with a header provided by the system C library to implement ISO C requirements for certain macros to be predefined that describe properties of the whole implementation rather than just the compiler.
10716 @end deftypefn
10717
10718 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C (const char*@var{})
10719 Define this hook to add target-specific C++ implicit extern C functions. If this function returns true for the name of a file-scope function, that function implicitly gets extern "C" linkage rather than whatever language linkage the declaration would normally have. An example of such function is WinMain on Win32 targets.
10720 @end deftypefn
10721
10722 @defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10723 Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10724 This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10725 C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10726 @samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10727 @end defmac
10728
10729 @findex #pragma
10730 @findex pragma
10731 @defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
10732 Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
10733 If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
10734 @code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10735 for each pragma. The macro may also do any
10736 setup required for the pragmas.
10737
10738 The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10739 other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
10740 definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
10741
10742 If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
10743 defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
10744
10745 Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10746 @samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
10747 silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
10748 @end defmac
10749
10750 @deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10751 @deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10752
10753 Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10754 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
10755 @var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10756 pragma of the form
10757
10758 @smallexample
10759 #pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10760 @end smallexample
10761
10762 @var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10763 @code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10764 routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
10765 on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
10766 @var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
10767 callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
10768 a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10769 arguments of pragmas registered with
10770 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10771 pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
10772
10773 Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
10774 compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
10775 other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
10776 to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
10777 building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
10778 variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
10779 target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
10780 the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
10781 code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
10782 rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10783 how to build this object file.
10784 @end deftypefun
10785
10786 @defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
10787 Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
10788 arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10789 @end defmac
10790
10791 @defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10792 If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
10793 the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
10794 This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
10795 @samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10796 @end defmac
10797
10798 @defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
10799 Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
10800 identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
10801 not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10802 there is no need to define this macro in that case.
10803 @end defmac
10804
10805 @defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10806 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10807 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10808 even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
10809 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
10810 every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10811 or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10812 you should define this macro.
10813
10814 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10815 @end defmac
10816
10817 @defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10818 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10819 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10820 even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10821 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10822 some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10823 are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10824 define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10825 instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10826 slot of @var{insn}.
10827
10828 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10829 @end defmac
10830
10831 @defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
10832 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10833 global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10834 symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10835 instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10836 from shared libraries (DLLs).
10837
10838 You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
10839 @end defmac
10840
10841 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_MD_ASM_ADJUST (vec<rtx>& @var{outputs}, vec<rtx>& @var{inputs}, vec<const char *>& @var{constraints}, vec<rtx>& @var{clobbers}, HARD_REG_SET& @var{clobbered_regs})
10842 This target hook may add @dfn{clobbers} to @var{clobbers} and
10843 @var{clobbered_regs} for any hard regs the port wishes to automatically
10844 clobber for an asm. The @var{outputs} and @var{inputs} may be inspected
10845 to avoid clobbering a register that is already used by the asm.
10846
10847 It may modify the @var{outputs}, @var{inputs}, and @var{constraints}
10848 as necessary for other pre-processing. In this case the return value is
10849 a sequence of insns to emit after the asm.
10850 @end deftypefn
10851
10852 @defmac MATH_LIBRARY
10853 Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
10854 in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10855 @samp{""} if the target does not have a
10856 separate math library.
10857
10858 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
10859 @end defmac
10860
10861 @defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
10862 Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10863 specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10864
10865 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10866 is wrong.
10867 @end defmac
10868
10869 @defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10870 Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10871 functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10872 Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
10873 to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
10874 if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
10875 for cross-profiling.
10876 @end defmac
10877
10878 @defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
10879
10880 A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10881 conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10882 @code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
10883 1 if it does use cc0.
10884 @end defmac
10885
10886 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10887 Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10888 conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10889 @var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10890 contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10891 and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10892 then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10893 @var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
10894 @end defmac
10895
10896 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10897 Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10898 if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10899 @var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10900 being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
10901 @end defmac
10902
10903 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
10904 A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10905 be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10906 a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10907 about the currently processed blocks.
10908 @end defmac
10909
10910 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
10911 A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
10912 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10913 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10914 to by @var{ce_info}.
10915 @end defmac
10916
10917 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
10918 A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
10919 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10920 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10921 to by @var{ce_info}.
10922 @end defmac
10923
10924 @defmac IFCVT_MACHDEP_INIT (@var{ce_info})
10925 A C expression to initialize any machine specific data for if-conversion
10926 of the if-block in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10927 to by @var{ce_info}.
10928 @end defmac
10929
10930 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (void)
10931 If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10932 instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10933 just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10934
10935 The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
10936 it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10937 laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10938 Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10939
10940 You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
10941 definition is null.
10942 @end deftypefn
10943
10944 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS (void)
10945 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10946 that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
10947 necessary setup.
10948
10949 Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
10950 instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10951 they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10952 instructions or prefetch instructions).
10953
10954 To create a built-in function, call the function
10955 @code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
10956 which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
10957 up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes};
10958 only language front ends that use those two functions will call
10959 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
10960 @end deftypefn
10961
10962 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL (unsigned @var{code}, bool @var{initialize_p})
10963 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10964 that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
10965 builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10966 If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10967 if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10968 If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10969 @code{error_mark_node}.
10970 @end deftypefn
10971
10972 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
10973
10974 Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10975 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
10976 function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10977 convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10978 @var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10979 @var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10980 ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
10981 built-in function.
10982 @end deftypefn
10983
10984 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_CHKP_FUNCTION (unsigned @var{fcode})
10985 This hook allows target to redefine built-in functions used by
10986 Pointer Bounds Checker for code instrumentation. Hook should return
10987 fndecl of function implementing generic builtin whose code is
10988 passed in @var{fcode}. Currently following built-in functions are
10989 obtained using this hook:
10990 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndmk (const void *@var{lb}, size_t @var{size})
10991 Function code - BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDMK. This built-in function is used
10992 by Pointer Bounds Checker to create bound values. @var{lb} holds low
10993 bound of the resulting bounds. @var{size} holds size of created bounds.
10994 @end deftypefn
10995
10996 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndstx (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b}, const void **@var{loc})
10997 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDSTX}. This built-in function is used
10998 by Pointer Bounds Checker to store bounds @var{b} for pointer @var{ptr}
10999 when @var{ptr} is stored by address @var{loc}.
11000 @end deftypefn
11001
11002 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndldx (const void **@var{loc}, const void *@var{ptr})
11003 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDLDX}. This built-in function is used
11004 by Pointer Bounds Checker to get bounds of pointer @var{ptr} loaded by
11005 address @var{loc}.
11006 @end deftypefn
11007
11008 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndcl (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b})
11009 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDCL}. This built-in function is used
11010 by Pointer Bounds Checker to perform check for pointer @var{ptr} against
11011 lower bound of bounds @var{b}.
11012 @end deftypefn
11013
11014 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndcu (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b})
11015 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDCU}. This built-in function is used
11016 by Pointer Bounds Checker to perform check for pointer @var{ptr} against
11017 upper bound of bounds @var{b}.
11018 @end deftypefn
11019
11020 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndret (void *@var{ptr})
11021 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDRET}. This built-in function is used
11022 by Pointer Bounds Checker to obtain bounds returned by a call statement.
11023 @var{ptr} passed to built-in is @code{SSA_NAME} returned by the call.
11024 @end deftypefn
11025
11026 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_intersect (__bounds_type @var{b1}, __bounds_type @var{b2})
11027 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_INTERSECT}. This built-in function
11028 returns intersection of bounds @var{b1} and @var{b2}.
11029 @end deftypefn
11030
11031 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_narrow (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b}, size_t @var{s})
11032 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_NARROW}. This built-in function
11033 returns intersection of bounds @var{b} and
11034 [@var{ptr}, @var{ptr} + @var{s} - @code{1}].
11035 @end deftypefn
11036
11037 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} size_t __chkp_sizeof (const void *@var{ptr})
11038 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_SIZEOF}. This built-in function
11039 returns size of object referenced by @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} is always
11040 @code{ADDR_EXPR} of @code{VAR_DECL}. This built-in is used by
11041 Pointer Bounds Checker when bounds of object cannot be computed statically
11042 (e.g. object has incomplete type).
11043 @end deftypefn
11044
11045 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} const void *__chkp_extract_lower (__bounds_type @var{b})
11046 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_EXTRACT_LOWER}. This built-in function
11047 returns lower bound of bounds @var{b}.
11048 @end deftypefn
11049
11050 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} const void *__chkp_extract_upper (__bounds_type @var{b})
11051 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_EXTRACT_UPPER}. This built-in function
11052 returns upper bound of bounds @var{b}.
11053 @end deftypefn
11054 @end deftypefn
11055 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CHKP_BOUND_TYPE (void)
11056 Return type to be used for bounds
11057 @end deftypefn
11058 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_CHKP_BOUND_MODE (void)
11059 Return mode to be used for bounds.
11060 @end deftypefn
11061 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CHKP_MAKE_BOUNDS_CONSTANT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{lb}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{ub})
11062 Return constant used to statically initialize constant bounds
11063 with specified lower bound @var{lb} and upper bounds @var{ub}.
11064 @end deftypefn
11065 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CHKP_INITIALIZE_BOUNDS (tree @var{var}, tree @var{lb}, tree @var{ub}, tree *@var{stmts})
11066 Generate a list of statements @var{stmts} to initialize pointer
11067 bounds variable @var{var} with bounds @var{lb} and @var{ub}. Return
11068 the number of generated statements.
11069 @end deftypefn
11070
11071 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN (unsigned int @var{loc}, tree @var{fndecl}, void *@var{arglist})
11072 Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
11073 was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
11074 @emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
11075 implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
11076 declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
11077 arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
11078 complete expression that implements the operation, usually
11079 another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
11080 @var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
11081 @end deftypefn
11082
11083 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{n_args}, tree *@var{argp}, bool @var{ignore})
11084 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
11085 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
11086 built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
11087 the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
11088 The result is another tree, valid for both GIMPLE and GENERIC,
11089 containing a simplified expression for the call's result. If
11090 @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
11091 @end deftypefn
11092
11093 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GIMPLE_FOLD_BUILTIN (gimple_stmt_iterator *@var{gsi})
11094 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up
11095 by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{gsi} points to the gimple
11096 statement holding the function call. Returns true if any change
11097 was made to the GIMPLE stream.
11098 @end deftypefn
11099
11100 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPARE_VERSION_PRIORITY (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
11101 This hook is used to compare the target attributes in two functions to
11102 determine which function's features get higher priority. This is used
11103 during function multi-versioning to figure out the order in which two
11104 versions must be dispatched. A function version with a higher priority
11105 is checked for dispatching earlier. @var{decl1} and @var{decl2} are
11106 the two function decls that will be compared.
11107 @end deftypefn
11108
11109 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GET_FUNCTION_VERSIONS_DISPATCHER (void *@var{decl})
11110 This hook is used to get the dispatcher function for a set of function
11111 versions. The dispatcher function is called to invoke the right function
11112 version at run-time. @var{decl} is one version from a set of semantically
11113 identical versions.
11114 @end deftypefn
11115
11116 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GENERATE_VERSION_DISPATCHER_BODY (void *@var{arg})
11117 This hook is used to generate the dispatcher logic to invoke the right
11118 function version at run-time for a given set of function versions.
11119 @var{arg} points to the callgraph node of the dispatcher function whose
11120 body must be generated.
11121 @end deftypefn
11122
11123 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_USE_DOLOOP_P (const widest_int @var{&iterations}, const widest_int @var{&iterations_max}, unsigned int @var{loop_depth}, bool @var{entered_at_top})
11124 Return true if it is possible to use low-overhead loops (@code{doloop_end}
11125 and @code{doloop_begin}) for a particular loop. @var{iterations} gives the
11126 exact number of iterations, or 0 if not known. @var{iterations_max} gives
11127 the maximum number of iterations, or 0 if not known. @var{loop_depth} is
11128 the nesting depth of the loop, with 1 for innermost loops, 2 for loops that
11129 contain innermost loops, and so on. @var{entered_at_top} is true if the
11130 loop is only entered from the top.
11131
11132 This hook is only used if @code{doloop_end} is available. The default
11133 implementation returns true. You can use @code{can_use_doloop_if_innermost}
11134 if the loop must be the innermost, and if there are no other restrictions.
11135 @end deftypefn
11136
11137 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP (const rtx_insn *@var{insn})
11138
11139 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
11140 low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
11141 could not be applied.
11142
11143 Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
11144 instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
11145 the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
11146 By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
11147 loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
11148 @end deftypefn
11149
11150 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_COMBINED_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn})
11151 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return @code{false} if the instruction is not appropriate as a combination of two or more instructions. The default is to accept all instructions.
11152 @end deftypefn
11153
11154 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_FOLLOW_JUMP (const rtx_insn *@var{follower}, const rtx_insn *@var{followee})
11155 FOLLOWER and FOLLOWEE are JUMP_INSN instructions; return true if FOLLOWER may be modified to follow FOLLOWEE; false, if it can't. For example, on some targets, certain kinds of branches can't be made to follow through a hot/cold partitioning.
11156 @end deftypefn
11157
11158 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P (const_rtx @var{x}, int @var{outer_code})
11159 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
11160 Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
11161 PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
11162 of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
11163 @end deftypefn
11164
11165 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE (rtx @var{hard_reg})
11166
11167 When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
11168 register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
11169 to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
11170 it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
11171 is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
11172 that had its initial value copied by using
11173 @code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
11174 Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
11175 to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
11176 the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
11177 @code{MEM}.
11178 If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
11179 it might decide to use another register anyways.
11180 You may use @code{current_function_is_leaf} or
11181 @code{REG_N_SETS} in the hook to determine if the hard
11182 register in question will not be clobbered.
11183 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
11184 allocation.
11185 @end deftypefn
11186
11187 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P (const_rtx @var{x}, unsigned @var{flags})
11188 This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
11189 @code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
11190 this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
11191 @code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
11192 to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
11193 passed along.
11194 @end deftypefn
11195
11196 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION (tree @var{decl})
11197 The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
11198 context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
11199 the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
11200 per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
11201 attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
11202 The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
11203 and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
11204 and is returning to processing at the top level.
11205 The default hook function does nothing.
11206
11207 GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
11208 some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
11209 situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
11210 or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
11211 @code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
11212 outside of any function scope.
11213 @end deftypefn
11214
11215 @defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
11216 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
11217 files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
11218 use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
11219 @end defmac
11220
11221 @defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
11222 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
11223 automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
11224 do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
11225 executable files.
11226 @end defmac
11227
11228 @defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
11229 If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
11230 specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
11231 Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
11232 object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
11233 lists.
11234 @end defmac
11235
11236 @defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
11237 Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
11238 method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
11239 must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
11240 For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
11241 the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
11242 defined as this expression:
11243
11244 @smallexample
11245 build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
11246 build_tree_list
11247 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
11248 NULL))
11249 @end smallexample
11250 @end defmac
11251
11252 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
11253 This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
11254 instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
11255 every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11256 reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11257
11258 @smallexample
11259 static bool
11260 cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11261 @{
11262 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11263 @}
11264 @end smallexample
11265 @end deftypefn
11266
11267 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS (void)
11268 This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
11269 optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
11270 usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
11271 re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
11272 to inter-block scheduling.
11273 @end deftypefn
11274
11275 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED (bool @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen})
11276 Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
11277 registers
11278 that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11279 returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
11280 that all target registers in the class returned by
11281 @samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11282 saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11283 epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
11284 true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11285 to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11286 to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11287 @end deftypefn
11288
11289 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION (void)
11290 This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11291 This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11292 modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11293 @end deftypefn
11294
11295 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GEN_CCMP_FIRST (rtx *@var{prep_seq}, rtx *@var{gen_seq}, int @var{code}, tree @var{op0}, tree @var{op1})
11296 This function prepares to emit a comparison insn for the first compare in a
11297 sequence of conditional comparisions. It returns a appropriate @code{CC}
11298 for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}. The insns to
11299 prepare the compare are saved in @var{prep_seq} and the compare insns are
11300 saved in @var{gen_seq}. They will be emitted when all the compares in the
11301 the conditional comparision are generated without error. @var{code} is
11302 the @code{rtx_code} of the compare for @var{op0} and @var{op1}.
11303 @end deftypefn
11304
11305 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GEN_CCMP_NEXT (rtx *@var{prep_seq}, rtx *@var{gen_seq}, rtx @var{prev}, int @var{cmp_code}, tree @var{op0}, tree @var{op1}, int @var{bit_code})
11306 This function prepare to emit a conditional comparison within a sequence of
11307 conditional comparisons. It returns a appropriate @code{CC} for passing to
11308 @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}. The insns to prepare the
11309 compare are saved in @var{prep_seq} and the compare insns are saved in
11310 @var{gen_seq}. They will be emitted when all the compares in the conditional
11311 comparision are generated without error. The @var{prev} expression is the
11312 result of a prior call to @code{gen_ccmp_first} or @code{gen_ccmp_next}. It
11313 may return @code{NULL} if the combination of @var{prev} and this comparison is
11314 not supported, otherwise the result must be appropriate for passing to
11315 @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}. @var{code} is the
11316 @code{rtx_code} of the compare for @var{op0} and @var{op1}. @var{bit_code}
11317 is @code{AND} or @code{IOR}, which is the op on the two compares.
11318 @end deftypefn
11319
11320 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST (unsigned @var{nunroll}, struct loop *@var{loop})
11321 This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11322 should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11323 the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11324 the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11325 is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11326 number of memory accesses.
11327 @end deftypefn
11328
11329 @defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11330 If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11331 that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11332 that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11333 constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11334 more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11335 system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11336 The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11337 @end defmac
11338
11339 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11340 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11341 target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11342 are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11343 The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11344 @end deftypefn
11345
11346 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11347 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11348 target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11349 indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11350 @var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11351 @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11352 @end deftypefn
11353
11354 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11355 This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11356 The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11357 systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11358 that are different from @option{-I}.
11359 @end deftypefn
11360
11361 @defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11362 This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11363 for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11364 @code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11365 functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11366 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11367 @end defmac
11368
11369 @defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11370 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11371 target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11372 option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11373 @end defmac
11374
11375 @defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11376 If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11377 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11378 @end defmac
11379
11380 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11381 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11382 target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11383 default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11384 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11385 @end defmac
11386
11387 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11388 If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11389 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11390 @end defmac
11391
11392 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11393 If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11394 routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11395 and scanf formatter settings.
11396 @end defmac
11397
11398 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN (const_tree @var{typelist}, const_tree @var{funcdecl}, const_tree @var{val})
11399 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11400 illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11401 with prototype @var{typelist}.
11402 @end deftypefn
11403
11404 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION (const_tree @var{fromtype}, const_tree @var{totype})
11405 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11406 invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11407 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11408 @end deftypefn
11409
11410 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type})
11411 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11412 invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11413 @code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11414 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11415 @end deftypefn
11416
11417 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
11418 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11419 invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11420 and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11421 the front end.
11422 @end deftypefn
11423
11424 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11425 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11426 invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
11427 or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11428 the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11429 @end deftypefn
11430
11431 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11432 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11433 invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
11434 or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11435 the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11436 @end deftypefn
11437
11438 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11439 If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11440 @var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11441 analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11442 front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11443 target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11444 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11445 @end deftypefn
11446
11447 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE (tree @var{type}, tree @var{expr})
11448 If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11449 @var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
11450 or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11451 This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11452 conversion rules.
11453 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11454 @end deftypefn
11455
11456 @defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11457 This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11458 classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11459 SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11460 @end defmac
11461
11462 @defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11463 This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11464 NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11465 @end defmac
11466
11467 @defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11468 Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
11469 to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
11470 call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11471 and the associated definitions of those functions.
11472 @end defmac
11473
11474 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY (void)
11475 Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11476 necessary.
11477 @end deftypefn
11478
11479 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX (void)
11480 This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11481 different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11482 argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11483 is needed.
11484 @end deftypefn
11485
11486 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS (void)
11487 When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11488 arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11489 stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11490 debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11491 @code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11492 cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11493 to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11494 false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11495 @end deftypefn
11496
11497 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11498 On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11499 a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11500 is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11501 is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11502 subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11503 the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11504 available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11505 constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11506 down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11507 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11508 accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11509 value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11510 MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11511 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11512 is zero, which disables this optimization.
11513 @end deftypevr
11514
11515 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_ASAN_SHADOW_OFFSET (void)
11516 Return the offset bitwise ored into shifted address to get corresponding
11517 Address Sanitizer shadow memory address. NULL if Address Sanitizer is not
11518 supported by the target.
11519 @end deftypefn
11520
11521 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_MEMMODEL_CHECK (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{val})
11522 Validate target specific memory model mask bits. When NULL no target specific
11523 memory model bits are allowed.
11524 @end deftypefn
11525
11526 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_ATOMIC_TEST_AND_SET_TRUEVAL
11527 This value should be set if the result written by @code{atomic_test_and_set} is not exactly 1, i.e. the @code{bool} @code{true}.
11528 @end deftypevr
11529
11530 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAS_IFUNC_P (void)
11531 It returns true if the target supports GNU indirect functions.
11532 The support includes the assembler, linker and dynamic linker.
11533 The default value of this hook is based on target's libc.
11534 @end deftypefn
11535
11536 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_ATOMIC_ALIGN_FOR_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
11537 If defined, this function returns an appropriate alignment in bits for an atomic object of machine_mode @var{mode}. If 0 is returned then the default alignment for the specified mode is used.
11538 @end deftypefn
11539
11540 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ATOMIC_ASSIGN_EXPAND_FENV (tree *@var{hold}, tree *@var{clear}, tree *@var{update})
11541 ISO C11 requires atomic compound assignments that may raise floating-point exceptions to raise exceptions corresponding to the arithmetic operation whose result was successfully stored in a compare-and-exchange sequence. This requires code equivalent to calls to @code{feholdexcept}, @code{feclearexcept} and @code{feupdateenv} to be generated at appropriate points in the compare-and-exchange sequence. This hook should set @code{*@var{hold}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feholdexcept}, @code{*@var{clear}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feclearexcept} and @code{*@var{update}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feupdateenv}. The three expressions are @code{NULL_TREE} on entry to the hook and may be left as @code{NULL_TREE} if no code is required in a particular place. The default implementation leaves all three expressions as @code{NULL_TREE}. The @code{__atomic_feraiseexcept} function from @code{libatomic} may be of use as part of the code generated in @code{*@var{update}}.
11542 @end deftypefn
11543
11544 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RECORD_OFFLOAD_SYMBOL (tree)
11545 Used when offloaded functions are seen in the compilation unit and no named
11546 sections are available. It is called once for each symbol that must be
11547 recorded in the offload function and variable table.
11548 @end deftypefn
11549
11550 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {char *} TARGET_OFFLOAD_OPTIONS (void)
11551 Used when writing out the list of options into an LTO file. It should
11552 translate any relevant target-specific options (such as the ABI in use)
11553 into one of the @option{-foffload} options that exist as a common interface
11554 to express such options. It should return a string containing these options,
11555 separated by spaces, which the caller will free.
11556
11557 @end deftypefn
11558
11559 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT
11560
11561 On older ports, large integers are stored in @code{CONST_DOUBLE} rtl
11562 objects. Newer ports define @code{TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT} to be nonzero
11563 to indicate that large integers are stored in
11564 @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} rtl objects. The @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} allows
11565 very large integer constants to be represented. @code{CONST_DOUBLE}
11566 is limited to twice the size of the host's @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}
11567 representation.
11568
11569 Converting a port mostly requires looking for the places where
11570 @code{CONST_DOUBLE}s are used with @code{VOIDmode} and replacing that
11571 code with code that accesses @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s. @samp{"grep -i
11572 const_double"} at the port level gets you to 95% of the changes that
11573 need to be made. There are a few places that require a deeper look.
11574
11575 @itemize @bullet
11576 @item
11577 There is no equivalent to @code{hval} and @code{lval} for
11578 @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s. This would be difficult to express in the md
11579 language since there are a variable number of elements.
11580
11581 Most ports only check that @code{hval} is either 0 or -1 to see if the
11582 value is small. As mentioned above, this will no longer be necessary
11583 since small constants are always @code{CONST_INT}. Of course there
11584 are still a few exceptions, the alpha's constraint used by the zap
11585 instruction certainly requires careful examination by C code.
11586 However, all the current code does is pass the hval and lval to C
11587 code, so evolving the c code to look at the @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} is
11588 not really a large change.
11589
11590 @item
11591 Because there is no standard template that ports use to materialize
11592 constants, there is likely to be some futzing that is unique to each
11593 port in this code.
11594
11595 @item
11596 The rtx costs may have to be adjusted to properly account for larger
11597 constants that are represented as @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}.
11598 @end itemize
11599
11600 All and all it does not take long to convert ports that the
11601 maintainer is familiar with.
11602
11603 @end defmac